flash: driver for Atmel SAMV, SAMS, and SAME
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Daemon Configuration:: Daemon Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB JLINK based
453 There are several OEM versions of the Segger @b{JLINK} adapter. It is
454 an example of a micro controller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{ATMEL SAMICE} Only works with ATMEL chips!
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/dyn/products/tools_card.asp?tool_id=3892}
460 @item @b{SEGGER JLINK}
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @* Link: @url{http://www.iar.com/en/products/hardware-debug-probes/iar-j-link/}
464 @end itemize
465
466 @section USB RLINK based
467 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
468 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
469 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
470
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
476 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
477 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
478 @end itemize
479
480 @section USB ST-LINK based
481 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
482 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
483
484 @itemize @bullet
485 @item @b{ST-LINK}
486 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
487 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
488 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
489 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
490 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
491 @end itemize
492
493 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
494 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
495 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
496 @itemize @bullet
497 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
498 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
499 @end itemize
500
501 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
502 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
503 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
504 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
505
506 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
507 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
508 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
509
510 @section USB Other
511 @itemize @bullet
512 @item @b{USBprog}
513 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
514
515 @item @b{USB - Presto}
516 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
517
518 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
519 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
520
521 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
522 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
523
524 @item @b{Buspirate}
525 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
526
527 @item @b{opendous}
528 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
529
530 @item @b{estick}
531 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
532
533 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
534 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
535 @end itemize
536
537 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
538
539 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
540 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
541 these on the market.
542
543 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
544 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
545 of USB-based ones.
546
547 @itemize @bullet
548
549 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
550 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
551
552 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
553 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
554 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
555
556 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Wiggler2}
560 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
561
562 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
563 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
564
565 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
566 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
567
568 @item @b{arm-jtag}
569 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
570
571 @item @b{chameleon}
572 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
573
574 @item @b{Triton}
575 @* Unknown.
576
577 @item @b{Lattice}
578 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
579 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
580
581 @item @b{flashlink}
582 @* From ST Microsystems;
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
584
585 @end itemize
586
587 @section Other...
588 @itemize @bullet
589
590 @item @b{ep93xx}
591 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
592
593 @item @b{at91rm9200}
594 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
595
596 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
597 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
598
599 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
600 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
601 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
602
603 @end itemize
604
605 @node About Jim-Tcl
606 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex Jim-Tcl
608 @cindex tcl
609
610 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
611 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
612 command interpreter.
613
614 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
615 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
616 much of anything about Tcl.
617 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
618
619 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
620 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
621 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
622 OpenOCD mailing list.
623
624 @itemize @bullet
625 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
626 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
627 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
628 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
629 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
630 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
631
632 @item @b{Missing Features}
633 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
634 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
635 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
636 enabled in OpenOCD.
637
638 @item @b{Scripts}
639 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
640 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
641 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
642
643 @item @b{Commands}
644 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
645 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
646 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
647 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
648
649 @item @b{Historical Note}
650 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
651 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
652 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
653 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
654
655 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
656 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
657 @end itemize
658
659 @node Running
660 @chapter Running
661 @cindex command line options
662 @cindex logfile
663 @cindex directory search
664
665 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
666 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
667 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
668 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
669 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
670 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
671 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
672
673 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
674 tell it how each debug session should work.
675 The @option{--help} option shows:
676 @verbatim
677 bash$ openocd --help
678
679 --help | -h display this help
680 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
681 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
682 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
683 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
684 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
685 --command | -c run <command>
686 @end verbatim
687
688 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
689 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
690 To specify one or more different
691 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
692
693 @example
694 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
695 @end example
696
697 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
698 @enumerate
699 @item the current directory,
700 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
701 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
702 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
703 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
704 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
705 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
706 @end enumerate
707 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
708
709 @quotation Note
710 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
711 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
712 @end quotation
713
714 @section Simple setup, no customization
715
716 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
717 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
718 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
719 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
720 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
721
722 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
723 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
724 the server with some variation of one of the following:
725
726 @example
727 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
729 @end example
730
731 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
732 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
733 If all goes well you'll see output something like
734
735 @example
736 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
737 For bug reports, read
738 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
739 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
740 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
741 @end example
742
743 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
744 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
745 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
746
747 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
748
749 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
750 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
751 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
752 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
753 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
754 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
755 ensure that this always succeeds.
756 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a daemon.
757 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
758 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
759 and then shut down without acting as a daemon.
760
761 Once OpenOCD starts running as a daemon, it waits for connections from
762 clients (Telnet, GDB, Other) and processes the commands issued through
763 those channels.
764
765 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
766 the @option{-d} option.
767
768 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
769 @option{-c} command line switch.
770
771 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
772 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
773 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
774 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
775 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
776 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
777 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
778
779 You can redirect all output from the daemon to a file using the
780 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
781
782 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
783 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
784 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
785 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
786
787 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
788 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
789
790 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
791 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
792 and start the OpenOCD server.
793 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
794 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
795 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
796 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
797
798 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
799
800 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
801 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
802 and a USB cable on the other.
803 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
804 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
805
806 @enumerate
807 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
808 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
809 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
810 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
811 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
812 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
813 debugging host.
814
815 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
816 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
817 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
818 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
819 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
820
821 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
822 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
823 with 1.2 Volt boards.
824
825 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
826 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
827 ways to connect the cable.
828 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
829 Be sure it's firmly connected.
830
831 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
832 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
833 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
834 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
835 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
836 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
837 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
838 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
839
840 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
841 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
842 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
843 but are tedious to set up.
844 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
845 adapter signals to the right board pins.
846
847 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
848 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
849 you are using to run OpenOCD.
850 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
851
852 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
853 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
854 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
855 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
856
857 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
858 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
859 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
860
861 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
862 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
863 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
864 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
865
866 @end enumerate
867
868 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
869 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
870 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
871
872 @section Project Directory
873
874 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
875
876 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
877 single directory for your work with a given board.
878 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
879 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
880 files accessed through semihosting,
881 and for code you upload to the target board.
882 It is also the natural place to write files,
883 such as log files and data you download from the board.
884
885 @section Configuration Basics
886
887 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
888 a variety of ways you can mix them.
889 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
890
891 @itemize
892 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
893 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
894 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
895 @end itemize
896
897 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
898 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
899 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
900
901 @example
902 source [find interface/signalyzer.cfg]
903
904 # GDB can also flash my flash!
905 gdb_memory_map enable
906 gdb_flash_program enable
907
908 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
909 @end example
910
911 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
912
913 @example
914 openocd -f interface/signalyzer.cfg \
915 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
916 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
917 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
918 @end example
919
920 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
921 each supporting a different development task.
922 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
923 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
924
925 @quotation Important
926 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
927 problems with how it treats variables.
928 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
929 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
930 that can be tested in a later script.
931 @end quotation
932
933 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
934 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
935 to simplify your work.
936
937 @section User Config Files
938 @cindex config file, user
939 @cindex user config file
940 @cindex config file, overview
941
942 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
943 in one place.
944 One of the following will match your situation best:
945
946 @itemize
947 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
948 provided by someone else.
949 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
950 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
951 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
952 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
953 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
954 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
955
956 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
957 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
958
959 @enumerate
960 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
961 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
962 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
963 @end enumerate
964
965 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
966 The first is an interface config file.
967 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
968 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
969 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
970 meet your deadline:
971
972 @example
973 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
974 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
975 @end example
976
977 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
978 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
979 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
980 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
981
982 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
983 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
984 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
985 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
986 target and board
987 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
988 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
989
990 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
991 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
992 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
993 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
994
995 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
996 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
997 giving access to your particular flash chips.
998 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
999 for a new chip built around the Cortex M3 core.
1000
1001 @quotation Note
1002 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1003 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1004 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1005 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1006 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1007 @end quotation
1008
1009 @item
1010 You may may need to write some C code.
1011 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1012 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1013 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1014 a new chip architecture.
1015 @end itemize
1016
1017 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1018 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1019 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1020
1021 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1022 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1023 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1024 @itemize
1025
1026 @item
1027 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1028 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1029 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1030 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1031
1032 @item
1033 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1034 @cindex vector_catch
1035 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1036 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1037 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1038 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1039 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1040 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1041
1042 @item
1043 You might need to override some defaults.
1044 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1045 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1046
1047 @item
1048 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1049 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1050 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1051 @end itemize
1052
1053 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1054
1055 A few project-specific utility
1056 routines may well speed up your work.
1057 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1058
1059 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1060 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1061 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1062 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1063 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1064 may help:
1065
1066 @example
1067 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1068 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1069 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1070 # Leave the CPU halted.
1071 reset init
1072
1073 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1074 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1075
1076 # Start running.
1077 resume 0x20000000
1078 @}
1079 @end example
1080
1081 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1082 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1083 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1084 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1085 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1086
1087 @example
1088 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1089 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1090 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1091 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1092 reset init
1093
1094 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1095 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1096 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1097 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1098 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1099 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1100 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1101
1102 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1103 reset run
1104 @}
1105 @end example
1106
1107 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1108 from NAND.
1109 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1110 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1111 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1112
1113 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1114 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1115
1116 @section Target Software Changes
1117
1118 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1119 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1120 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1121 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1122 handling issues like:
1123
1124 @itemize @bullet
1125
1126 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1127 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1128 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1129 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1130 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1131 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1132 your debug sessions.
1133
1134 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1135 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1136 That might however be your only option.
1137
1138 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1139 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1140 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1141 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1142 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1143 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1144 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1145 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1146 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1147 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1148 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1149 instead of the whole thing.
1150 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1151 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1152
1153 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1154 @cindex ARM semihosting
1155 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1156 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1157 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1158 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1159 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1160 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1161 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1162 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1163 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1164 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1165 NAND or SPI flash.
1166
1167 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1168 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1169 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1170 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1171 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1172
1173 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1174 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1175 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1176 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1177 registers which can be used to change various features including
1178 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1179 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1180 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1181 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1182 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1183
1184 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1185 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1186 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1187 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1188 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1189
1190 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1191 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1192 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1193 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1194 early code execution can be debugged
1195 or firmware can be replaced.
1196
1197 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1198 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1199 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1200 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1201 operations like writing to memory.)
1202
1203 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1204 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1205 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1206 various kinds of message.
1207 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1208
1209 @end itemize
1210
1211 @section Target Hardware Setup
1212
1213 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1214 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1215 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1216 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1217 working with.}
1218
1219 Common issues include:
1220
1221 @itemize @bullet
1222
1223 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1224 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1225 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1226 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1227 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1228 or one from a daughtercard).
1229 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1230 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1231
1232 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1233 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1234 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1235 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1236 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1237 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1238
1239 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1240 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1241 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1242 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1243 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1244
1245
1246 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1247 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1248 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1249 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1250 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1251 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1252 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1253
1254 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1255 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1256 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1257 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1258 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1259
1260 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1261 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1262 used to start booting.
1263
1264 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1265 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1266 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1267 multiple audio codec chips).
1268 This interacts with software
1269 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1270 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1271 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1272 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1273 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1274 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1275 audio or video codecs are used.
1276
1277 @end itemize
1278
1279 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1280 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1281 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1282 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1283 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1284 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1285 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1286 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1287 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1288 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1289
1290
1291 @node Config File Guidelines
1292 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1293
1294 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1295 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1296 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1297 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1298
1299 You should find the following directories under
1300 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1301 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1302 @itemize @bullet
1303 @item @file{interface} ...
1304 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1305 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1306 @item @file{board} ...
1307 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1308 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1309
1310 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1311 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1312 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1313 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1314 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1315 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1316 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1317 a CPU and an FPGA.
1318 @item @file{target} ...
1319 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1320 on a chip
1321 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1322 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1323 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1324 the target config file defines all of them.
1325 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1326 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1327 @end itemize
1328
1329 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1330 file may override features in any of the above files by
1331 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1332 commands specific to their situation.
1333
1334 @section Interface Config Files
1335
1336 The user config file
1337 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1338
1339 @example
1340 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1341 @end example
1342
1343 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1344 in use today with OpenOCD.
1345 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1346 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1347
1348 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1349 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1350 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1351 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1352 and need to provide a driver for it.
1353
1354 @section Board Config Files
1355 @cindex config file, board
1356 @cindex board config file
1357
1358 The user config file
1359 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1360
1361 @example
1362 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1363 @end example
1364
1365 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1366 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1367 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1368
1369 @enumerate
1370 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1371 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1372 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1373 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1374 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1375 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1376 @end enumerate
1377
1378 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1379 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1380 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1381 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1382
1383 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1384 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1385 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1386 configuration works.
1387
1388 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1389
1390 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1391 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1392 convention on how to use certain variables.
1393
1394 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1395 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1396 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1397 used at will within a target configuration file.
1398
1399 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1400 for a board with three chips:
1401
1402 @example
1403 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1404 set CHIPNAME network
1405 set ENDIAN big
1406 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1407 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1408 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1409 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1410
1411 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1412 set CHIPNAME video
1413 set ENDIAN little
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1420 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1421 unset ENDIAN
1422 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1423 @end example
1424
1425 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1426 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1427 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1428 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1429 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1430 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1431 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1432 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1433
1434 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1435 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1436 naming collisions.
1437
1438 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1439 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1440 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1441 up other clocks and peripherals.
1442
1443 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1444 @cindex variable names
1445
1446 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1447 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1448 one such chip (as shown above).
1449 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1450 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1451 to promote consistency and
1452 so that board files can override target defaults.
1453
1454 Inputs to target config files include:
1455
1456 @itemize @bullet
1457 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1458 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1459 tap identifier dotted names.
1460 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1461 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1462 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1463 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1464 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1465 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1466 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1467 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1468 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1469 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1470 @end itemize
1471
1472 Outputs from target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1476 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1477 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1478 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1479 specific to that board and that target.
1480 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1481 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1482 @end itemize
1483
1484 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1485 @cindex event, reset-init
1486 @cindex reset-init handler
1487
1488 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1489 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1490 fully set up yet.
1491 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1492 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1493 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1494 handler is one of the most important.
1495
1496 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1497 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1498 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1499 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1500 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1501
1502 @quotation Note
1503 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1504 are included here.
1505 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1506 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1507 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1508 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1509 @end quotation
1510
1511 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1512 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1513 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1514 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1515 those as parameters.
1516 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1517 and disabling the watchdog.
1518 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1519 the next developer doing such work.
1520 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1521
1522 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1523 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1524 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1525 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1526
1527 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1528
1529 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1530 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1531 a low JTAG clock rate.
1532 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1533 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1534 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1535 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1536 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1537 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1538 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1539
1540 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1541 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1542 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1543 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1544 which might be less than that.
1545
1546 @quotation Warning
1547 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1548 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1549 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1550 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1551 @end quotation
1552
1553 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1554 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1555 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1556 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1557 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1558 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1559
1560 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1561 @subsection The init_board procedure
1562 @cindex init_board procedure
1563
1564 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1565 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1566 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1567 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1568 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1569 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1570 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1571 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1572 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1573 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1574 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1575 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1576
1577 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1578 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1579
1580 @example
1581 ### board_file.cfg ###
1582
1583 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1584 source [find target/target.cfg]
1585
1586 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1587 # enables fast on-board clock source
1588 # configures the chip to use it
1589 @}
1590
1591 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1592 proc init_board @{@} @{
1593 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1594
1595 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1596 adapter_khz 1
1597 enable_fast_clock
1598 adapter_khz 10000
1599 @}
1600 @}
1601 @end example
1602
1603 @section Target Config Files
1604 @cindex config file, target
1605 @cindex target config file
1606
1607 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1608 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1609 more target config files like this:
1610
1611 @example
1612 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1613 @end example
1614
1615 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1616 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1617 In summary the target files should contain
1618
1619 @enumerate
1620 @item Set defaults
1621 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1622 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1623 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1624 @item On-Chip flash
1625 @end enumerate
1626
1627 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1628 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1629 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1630
1631 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1632 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1633 can talk to the chip.
1634 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1635 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1636 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1637 and other processing engines.
1638
1639 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1640
1641 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1642 letting board config files express environment-specific
1643 differences in how things should be set up.
1644
1645 @example
1646 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1647 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1648 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1649 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1650 @} else @{
1651 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1652 @}
1653
1654 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1655 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1656 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1657 @} else @{
1658 set _ENDIAN little
1659 @}
1660
1661 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1662 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1663 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1664 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1665 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1666 @} else @{
1667 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1668 @}
1669 @end example
1670 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1671
1672 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1673 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1674 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1675
1676 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1677 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1678 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1679
1680 @example
1681 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1682 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1683 @end example
1684
1685 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1686 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1687 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1688 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1689 for taps.
1690
1691 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1692 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1693 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1694 looks (in part) like this:
1695
1696 @example
1697 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1698 @end example
1699
1700 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1701 to source such a config file twice, with different
1702 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1703 it adds a different TAP each time.
1704
1705 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1706 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1707 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1708 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1709
1710 @example
1711 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1712 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1713 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1714 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1715 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1716 @end example
1717
1718 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1719 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1720
1721 @itemize
1722 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1723 plus a JRC to enable them
1724 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1725 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1726 is not currently used)
1727 @end itemize
1728
1729 @subsection Add CPU targets
1730
1731 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1732 GDB and other commands can use it.
1733 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1734 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1735 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1736 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1737
1738 @example
1739 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1740 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1741 @end example
1742
1743 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1744 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1745 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1746 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1747 a work area if you can.
1748 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1749
1750 @example
1751 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1752 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1753 @end example
1754
1755 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1756 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1757 @cindex SMP
1758 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1759
1760 @example
1761 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1762 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1763 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1764 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1765 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1766 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1767 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1768 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1769 @end example
1770 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1771 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1772 @itemize @bullet
1773 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1774 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1775 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1776 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1777 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1778 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1779 @end itemize
1780
1781 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1782 command have been implemented.
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1785 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1786 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1787 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1788 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1789 following example.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 @example
1793 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1794 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1795 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1796 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1797 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1798 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1799 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1800 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1801 > resume
1802 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1803 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1804 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1805 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1806 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1807 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1808 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1809 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1810 @end example
1811
1812
1813 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1814
1815 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1816 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1817 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1818
1819 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1820 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1821 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1822 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1823 both signals.
1824
1825 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1826 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1827 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1828 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1829 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1830 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1831 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1832 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1833 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1834 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1835 not available.)
1836
1837 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1838 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1839 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1840 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1841 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1842 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1843 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1844 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1845
1846 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1847 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1848 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1849 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1850 slower clock than they will use later.
1851 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1852 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1853 than they will use later.
1854 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1855
1856 @quotation Important
1857 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1858 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1859 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1860 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1861 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1862 @end quotation
1863
1864 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1865 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1866 @cindex init_targets procedure
1867
1868 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1869 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1870 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1871 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1872 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1873 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1874 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1875 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1876 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1877
1878 @example
1879 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1880
1881 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1882 # basic initialization procedure ...
1883 @}
1884
1885 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1886 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1887 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1888 @}
1889
1890 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1891
1892 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1893
1894 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1895 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1896 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1897 @}
1898 @end example
1899
1900 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1901 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1902
1903 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1904
1905 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1906 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1907
1908 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1909 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1910 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1911
1912 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1913 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1914 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1915 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1916 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1917 events already assigned.
1918
1919 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1920
1921 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1922 special high speed download features - enable it.
1923
1924 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1925
1926 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1927 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1928 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1929 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1930 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1931 If you are using an external trace port,
1932 configure it in your board config file.
1933 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1934 configure it in your target config file.
1935
1936 @example
1937 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1938 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1939 @end example
1940
1941 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1942
1943 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1944
1945 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1946 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1947 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1948 the TARGET (chip) file.
1949
1950 Examples:
1951 @itemize @bullet
1952 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1953 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1954 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1955 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1956 @end itemize
1957
1958 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1959 @section Translating Configuration Files
1960 @cindex translation
1961 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1962 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1963 Lauterbach, Segger, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1964 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1965 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1966 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1967
1968 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1969 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1970 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1971 convert other scripts later on.
1972
1973 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1974 replace job:
1975
1976 @example
1977 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1978 #
1979 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1980 #
1981 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1982 #
1983 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1984
1985 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1986 global TARGETNAME
1987
1988 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1989
1990 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1992 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1993 @}
1994 @end example
1995
1996
1997
1998 @node Daemon Configuration
1999 @chapter Daemon Configuration
2000 @cindex initialization
2001 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2002 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2003 supported.
2004
2005 @anchor{configurationstage}
2006 @section Configuration Stage
2007 @cindex configuration stage
2008 @cindex config command
2009
2010 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2011 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2012 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2013 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2014 inside startup scripts.
2015
2016 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2017 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2018 which may be issued interactively.
2019 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2020 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2021
2022 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2023 flash banks,
2024 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2025 and other basic setup.
2026 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2027 may access or activate TAPs.
2028 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2029 longer be issued.
2030
2031 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2032 @section Entering the Run Stage
2033
2034 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2035 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2036 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2037 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2038 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2039 You should see no errors at this point.
2040 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2041 commands you used to configure the server.
2042 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2043 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2044 on the scan chain.
2045
2046 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2047 become available.
2048 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2049 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2050 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2051 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2052 entry to the run stage.
2053
2054 @deffn {Config Command} init
2055 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2056 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2057 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2058 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2059 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2060 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2061
2062 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2063 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2064 configuration files and/or command line options.
2065
2066 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2067 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2068 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2069 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2070 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2071 @end deffn
2072
2073 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2074 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2075 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2076
2077 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2078 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2079 scan chain.
2080 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2081 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2082
2083 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2084 they return.
2085 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2086 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2087 @end deffn
2088
2089 @anchor{tcpipports}
2090 @section TCP/IP Ports
2091 @cindex TCP port
2092 @cindex server
2093 @cindex port
2094 @cindex security
2095 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2096 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2097 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2098
2099 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2100 access using one or more of these ports.
2101 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as zero.
2102 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2103 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2104
2105 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2106 @cindex GDB server
2107 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2108 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2109 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2110 the normal use cases.
2111
2112 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2113 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disable"
2114 disables the gdb server.
2115
2116 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2117 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2118
2119 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2120 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2121
2122 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2123 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2124 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2125
2126 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2127 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2128 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2129 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2130
2131 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2132 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2133 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2134
2135 @end deffn
2136
2137 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2138 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2139 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2140 output from the Tcl engine.
2141 Intended as a machine interface.
2142 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2143 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2144
2145 @end deffn
2146
2147 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2148 Specify or query the
2149 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2150 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2151 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2152 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2153 When specified as zero, this port is not activated.
2154 @end deffn
2155
2156 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2157 @section GDB Configuration
2158 @cindex GDB
2159 @cindex GDB configuration
2160 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2161 The ones listed here are static and global.
2162 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2163 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2164
2165 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2166 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2167 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2168 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2169 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2170 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2171 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2172 @end deffn
2173
2174 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2175 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2176 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2177 vFlash packet is received.
2178 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2179 @end deffn
2180
2181 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2182 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2183 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2184 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2185 for flash programming to work.
2186 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2187 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2188 @end deffn
2189
2190 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2191 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2192 by GDB memory read packets.
2193 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2194 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2195 @end deffn
2196
2197 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2198 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2199 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2200 @end deffn
2201
2202 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2203 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2204
2205 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2206 @end deffn
2207
2208 @anchor{eventpolling}
2209 @section Event Polling
2210
2211 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2212 where significant events can happen at any time.
2213 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2214 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2215 or to GDB.
2216
2217 Examples of such events include:
2218
2219 @itemize
2220 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2221 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2222 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2223 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2224 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2225 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2226 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2227 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2228 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2229 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2230 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2231 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2232 @end itemize
2233
2234 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2235 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2236 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2237 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2238 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2239
2240 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2241 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2242 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2243 to the various active targets.
2244 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2245 which is normally done in the background.
2246
2247 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2248 Poll the current target for its current state.
2249 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2250 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2251 specific information about the current state is printed.
2252 An optional parameter
2253 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2254
2255 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2256 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2257 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2258 @example
2259 > poll
2260 background polling: on
2261 target state: halted
2262 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2263 current mode: Supervisor
2264 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2265 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2266 >
2267 @end example
2268 @end deffn
2269
2270 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2272 @cindex config file, interface
2273 @cindex interface config file
2274
2275 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2276 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2277 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2278
2279 @quotation Note
2280 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2281 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2282 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2283 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2284 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2285 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2286 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2287 @end quotation
2288
2289 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2290 through commands in an interface configuration
2291 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2292 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2293
2294 @example
2295 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2296 @end example
2297
2298 These commands tell
2299 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2300 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2301
2302 @example
2303 # jlink interface
2304 interface jlink
2305 @end example
2306
2307 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2308
2309
2310 @section Interface Configuration
2311
2312 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2313 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2314 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2315
2316 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2317 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2318 target.
2319 @end deffn
2320
2321 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2322 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2323 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2324 @end deffn
2325 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2326 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2327 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2328 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2329 the hardware can support.
2330 @end deffn
2331
2332
2333
2334 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2335 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2336 @end deffn
2337
2338 @section Interface Drivers
2339
2340 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2341 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2342 available at run time.
2343
2344 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2345 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2346 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2347 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2348
2349 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2350 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2351 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2352 @end deffn
2353
2354 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2355 Displays status of RTCK option.
2356 Optionally sets that option first.
2357 @end deffn
2358 @end deffn
2359
2360 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2361 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2362 This has one driver-specific command:
2363
2364 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2365 Logs some status
2366 @end deffn
2367 @end deffn
2368
2369 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2370 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2371 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2372 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2373 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2374 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2375 @end deffn
2376
2377 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2378 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2379
2380 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2381 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2382 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2383 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2384 @example
2385 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2386 @end example
2387 @end deffn
2388
2389 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2390 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2391 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2395 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2396 @end deffn
2397 @end deffn
2398
2399 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2400 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2401 @end deffn
2402
2403 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2404 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2405 @end deffn
2406
2407 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft2232}
2408 FTDI FT2232 (USB) based devices over one of the userspace libraries.
2409
2410 Note that this driver has several flaws and the @command{ftdi} driver is
2411 recommended as its replacement.
2412
2413 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2414 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2415
2416 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_device_desc} description
2417 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2418 of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not
2419 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2420 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2421 @end deffn
2422
2423 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_serial} serial-number
2424 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the FTDI FT2232 device to use,
2425 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one FT2232 device
2426 is connected to the host.
2427 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2428 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2429 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2430 @end deffn
2431
2432 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_layout} name
2433 Each vendor's FT2232 device can use different GPIO signals
2434 to control output-enables, reset signals, and LEDs.
2435 Currently valid layout @var{name} values include:
2436 @itemize @minus
2437 @item @b{axm0432_jtag} Axiom AXM-0432
2438 @item @b{comstick} Hitex STR9 comstick
2439 @item @b{cortino} Hitex Cortino JTAG interface
2440 @item @b{evb_lm3s811} TI/Luminary Micro EVB_LM3S811 as a JTAG interface,
2441 either for the local Cortex-M3 (SRST only)
2442 or in a passthrough mode (neither SRST nor TRST)
2443 This layout can not support the SWO trace mechanism, and should be
2444 used only for older boards (before rev C).
2445 @item @b{luminary_icdi} This layout should be used with most TI/Luminary
2446 eval boards, including Rev C LM3S811 eval boards and the eponymous
2447 ICDI boards, to debug either the local Cortex-M3 or in passthrough mode
2448 to debug some other target. It can support the SWO trace mechanism.
2449 @item @b{flyswatter} Tin Can Tools Flyswatter
2450 @item @b{icebear} ICEbear JTAG adapter from Section 5
2451 @item @b{jtagkey} Amontec JTAGkey and JTAGkey-Tiny (and compatibles)
2452 @item @b{jtagkey2} Amontec JTAGkey2 (and compatibles)
2453 @item @b{m5960} American Microsystems M5960
2454 @item @b{olimex-jtag} Olimex ARM-USB-OCD and ARM-USB-Tiny
2455 @item @b{oocdlink} OOCDLink
2456 @c oocdlink ~= jtagkey_prototype_v1
2457 @item @b{redbee-econotag} Integrated with a Redbee development board.
2458 @item @b{redbee-usb} Integrated with a Redbee USB-stick development board.
2459 @item @b{sheevaplug} Marvell Sheevaplug development kit
2460 @item @b{signalyzer} Xverve Signalyzer
2461 @item @b{stm32stick} Hitex STM32 Performance Stick
2462 @item @b{turtelizer2} egnite Software turtelizer2
2463 @item @b{usbjtag} "USBJTAG-1" layout described in the OpenOCD diploma thesis
2464 @end itemize
2465 @end deffn
2466
2467 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2468 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT2232 device. If not specified, the FTDI
2469 default values are used.
2470 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2471 @example
2472 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2473 @end example
2474 @end deffn
2475
2476 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_latency} ms
2477 On some systems using FT2232 based JTAG interfaces the FT_Read function call in
2478 ft2232_read() fails to return the expected number of bytes. This can be caused by
2479 USB communication delays and has proved hard to reproduce and debug. Setting the
2480 FT2232 latency timer to a larger value increases delays for short USB packets but it
2481 also reduces the risk of timeouts before receiving the expected number of bytes.
2482 The OpenOCD default value is 2 and for some systems a value of 10 has proved useful.
2483 @end deffn
2484
2485 @deffn {Config Command} {ft2232_channel} channel
2486 Used to select the channel of the ft2232 chip to use (between 1 and 4).
2487 The default value is 1.
2488 @end deffn
2489
2490 For example, the interface config file for a
2491 Turtelizer JTAG Adapter looks something like this:
2492
2493 @example
2494 interface ft2232
2495 ft2232_device_desc "Turtelizer JTAG/RS232 Adapter"
2496 ft2232_layout turtelizer2
2497 ft2232_vid_pid 0x0403 0xbdc8
2498 @end example
2499 @end deffn
2500
2501 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2502 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2503 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2504 It is a complete rewrite to address a large number of problems with the ft2232
2505 interface driver.
2506
2507 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2508 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX. Performance-wise it is
2509 consistently faster than the ft2232 driver, sometimes several times faster.
2510
2511 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2512 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2513 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2514
2515 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2516 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2517 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2518 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2519 will be used for their customary purpose.
2520
2521 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2522 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2523 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2524 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2525
2526 @itemize @minus
2527 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2528 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2529 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2530 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2531 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2532 switching data and direction as necessary
2533 @end itemize
2534
2535 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2536 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2537
2538 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2539 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2540 default values are used.
2541 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2542 @example
2543 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2544 @end example
2545 @end deffn
2546
2547 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2548 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2549 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2550 during device selection.
2551 @end deffn
2552
2553 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2554 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2555 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2556 is connected to the host.
2557 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2558 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2559 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2563 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2564 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2565 @end deffn
2566
2567 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2568 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2569 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2570 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2571 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2572 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2573 and initially asserted reset signals.
2574 @end deffn
2575
2576 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2577 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2578 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2579 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2580 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2581 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2582 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2583 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2584 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected.
2585
2586 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2587 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2588 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2589 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2590 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2591 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2592
2593 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2594 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2595 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2596 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2597 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2598 are always driven by the FTDI.
2599
2600 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2601 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2602 @var{name}.
2603 @end deffn
2604
2605 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2606 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2607 @itemize @minus
2608 @item @option{0}, drive low
2609 @item @option{1}, drive high
2610 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2611 @end itemize
2612 @end deffn
2613
2614 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2615 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2616 @end deffn
2617
2618 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2619 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2620 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2621 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2622
2623 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2624 processors which are being simulated.
2625
2626 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2627 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2628 sockets instead of TCP.
2629 @end deffn
2630
2631 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2632 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2633 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2634 @end deffn
2635
2636 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2637 something like:
2638
2639 @example
2640 interface remote_bitbang
2641 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2642 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2643 @end example
2644
2645 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2646 named mysocket:
2647
2648 @example
2649 interface remote_bitbang
2650 remote_bitbang_port 0
2651 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2652 @end example
2653 @end deffn
2654
2655 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2656 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2657 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2658 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2659
2660 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2661 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2662 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2663 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2664 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2668 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2669 default values are used.
2670 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2671 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2672 @example
2673 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2674 @end example
2675 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2676 @example
2677 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2678 @end example
2679 @end deffn
2680
2681 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2682 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2683 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2684 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2685 target board.
2686
2687 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2688 @example
2689 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2690 reset_config srst_only
2691 @end example
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ftd2xx}|@option{ublast2})
2695 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2696 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2697 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2701 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2702 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2708 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2709 This has one driver-specific command:
2710
2711 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2712 Display either the address of the I/O port
2713 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2714 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2715 This is a write-once setting.
2716 @end deffn
2717 @end deffn
2718
2719 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2720 Segger J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD transports.
2721
2722 @quotation Compatibility Note
2723 Segger released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2724 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2725 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2726 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2727 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2728 target, and Segger firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2729 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2730 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2731 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2732 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2733 @end quotation
2734
2735 @deffn {Command} {jlink caps}
2736 Display the device firmware capabilities.
2737 @end deffn
2738 @deffn {Command} {jlink info}
2739 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2740 @end deffn
2741 @deffn {Command} {jlink hw_jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2742 Set the JTAG protocol version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG protocol version.
2743 @end deffn
2744 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2745 Display the J-Link configuration.
2746 @end deffn
2747 @deffn {Command} {jlink config kickstart} [val]
2748 Set the Kickstart power on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the Kickstart configuration.
2749 @end deffn
2750 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac_address} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2751 Set the MAC address of the J-Link Pro. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2752 @end deffn
2753 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2754 Set the IP configuration of the J-Link Pro, where A.B.C.D is the IP address,
2755 E the bit of the subnet mask and
2756 F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the IP configuration.
2757 @end deffn
2758 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb_address} [@option{0x00} to @option{0x03} or @option{0xff}]
2759 Set the USB address; this will also change the product id. Without argument, show the USB address.
2760 @end deffn
2761 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2762 Reset the current configuration.
2763 @end deffn
2764 @deffn {Command} {jlink config save}
2765 Save the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2766 @end deffn
2767 @deffn {Config} {jlink pid} val
2768 Set the USB PID of the interface. As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2769 @end deffn
2770 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} serial-number
2771 Set the @var{serial-number} of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected to the host.
2772 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2773
2774 Note that there may be leading zeros in the @var{serial-number} string
2775 that will not show in the Segger software, but must be specified here.
2776 Debug level 3 output contains serial numbers if there is a mismatch.
2777
2778 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2779 @end deffn
2780 @end deffn
2781
2782 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2783 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2784 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2785 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2786 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2787
2788 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2789 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2790 This is a write-once setting.
2791 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2792
2793 @itemize @minus
2794 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2795 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2796 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2797 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2798 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2799 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2800 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2801 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2802 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2803 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2804 some versions of
2805 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2806 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2807 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2808 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2809 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2810 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2811 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2812 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2813 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2814 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2815 @end itemize
2816 @end deffn
2817
2818 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2819 Display either the address of the I/O port
2820 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2821 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2822 This is a write-once setting.
2823
2824 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2825 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2826 you may encounter a problem.
2827 @end deffn
2828
2829 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2830 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2831 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2832 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2833 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2834 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2835
2836 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2837 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2838 @quotation Tip
2839 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2840 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2841 @example
2842 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2843 > adapter_khz 500
2844 @end example
2845 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2846 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2847 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2848 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2849 large set of samples.
2850 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2851 @example
2852 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2853 @end example
2854 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2855 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2856
2857 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2858 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2859 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2860 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2861 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2862 @end quotation
2863 @end deffn
2864
2865 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2866 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2867 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2868 @end deffn
2869
2870 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2871 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2872
2873 @example
2874 interface parport
2875 parport_port 0x278
2876 parport_cable wiggler
2877 @end example
2878 @end deffn
2879
2880 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2881 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2882 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2883 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2884 @end deffn
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2888 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2889 @end deffn
2890
2891 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2892 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2893 @end deffn
2894
2895 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2896 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2897
2898 @quotation Note
2899 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2900 which are not currently documented here.
2901 @end quotation
2902 @end deffn
2903
2904 @anchor{hla_interface}
2905 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2906 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2907 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2908 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2909
2910 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2911 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2912 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2913 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2914 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2915
2916 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2917 Currently Not Supported.
2918 @end deffn
2919
2920 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2921 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2922 @end deffn
2923
2924 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2925 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2926 @end deffn
2927
2928 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2929 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2930 @end deffn
2931
2932 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2933 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2934 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2935 @end deffn
2936 @end deffn
2937
2938 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2939 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2940 @end deffn
2941
2942 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2943 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2944 @end deffn
2945
2946 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2947 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2948 @end deffn
2949
2950 @quotation Note
2951 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2952 which are not currently documented here.
2953 @end quotation
2954
2955 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2956 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2957 No arguments: print status.
2958 @end deffn
2959
2960 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2961 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2962 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2963
2964 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2965 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2966 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2967 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2968 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2969 configuration on exit.
2970
2971 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2972 pinout.
2973
2974 @end deffn
2975
2976 @section Transport Configuration
2977 @cindex Transport
2978 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2979 and the debug adapter you are using,
2980 several transports may be available to
2981 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2982 @deffn Command {transport list}
2983 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2984 version of OpenOCD.
2985 @end deffn
2986
2987 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2988 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2989
2990 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2991 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2992 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2993 adapter's driver).
2994
2995 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2996 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2997 supported by the debug adapter.
2998
2999 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3000 transport, if any.
3001 @end deffn
3002
3003 @subsection JTAG Transport
3004 @cindex JTAG
3005 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3006 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3007 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3008 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3009 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3010 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3011
3012 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3013 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3014 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3015 hla_jtag}.
3016
3017 @subsection SWD Transport
3018 @cindex SWD
3019 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3020 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3021 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3022 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3023 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3024 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3025 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3026
3027 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3028 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3029 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3030 hla_swd}.
3031
3032 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3033 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3034 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3035 expected to change.
3036 @end deffn
3037 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3038 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3039 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3040 No parameters: displays current settings.
3041 @end deffn
3042
3043 @subsection SPI Transport
3044 @cindex SPI
3045 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3046 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3047 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3048 solution for flash programming.
3049
3050 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3051 @section JTAG Speed
3052 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3053 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3054 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3055 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3056 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3057 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3058 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3059 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3060 power management software that may be active.
3061
3062 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3063 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3064 target event handler.
3065 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3066 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3067 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3068 sets up those clocks).
3069 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3070 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3071 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3072 in the target config file.
3073 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3074 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3075 config file instead.
3076 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3077 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3078 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3079
3080 @example
3081 jtag_rclk 3000
3082 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3083 @end example
3084
3085 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3086 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3087 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3088 may not be the fastest solution.
3089
3090 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3091 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3092 which support adaptive clocking.
3093
3094 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3095 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3096 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3097 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3098 than the speed specified.
3099
3100 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3101 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3102 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3103 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3104
3105 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3106 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3107 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3108 JTAG clocking after setup.
3109 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3110 If the interface device can not
3111 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3112 @end deffn
3113
3114 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3115 @cindex adaptive clocking
3116 @cindex RTCK
3117 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3118 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3119 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3120 @example
3121 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3122 jtag_rclk 3000
3123 @end example
3124 @end defun
3125
3126 @node Reset Configuration
3127 @chapter Reset Configuration
3128 @cindex Reset Configuration
3129
3130 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3131 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3132 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3133 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3134 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3135 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3136 Please see the various board files for examples.
3137
3138 @quotation Note
3139 To maintainers and integrators:
3140 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3141 Normally the board configuration file
3142 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3143 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3144
3145 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3146 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3147 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3148 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3149 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3150 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3151 @end quotation
3152
3153 @section Types of Reset
3154
3155 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3156 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3157 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3158
3159 @itemize @bullet
3160 @item
3161 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3162 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3163 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3164 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3165 @item
3166 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3167 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3168 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3169 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3170 @item
3171 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3172 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3173 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3174 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3175 @item
3176 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3177 several other types of reset.
3178 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3179 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3180 There may be individual module resets.
3181 @end itemize
3182
3183 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3184 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3185 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3186 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3187 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3188 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3189 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3190 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3191 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3192
3193 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3194 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3195
3196 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3197 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3198 common issues are:
3199
3200 @itemize @bullet
3201
3202 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3203 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3204 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3205 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3206 when either of those signals is not connected.
3207 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3208 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3209 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3210 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3211
3212 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3213 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3214 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3215 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3216
3217 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3218 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3219 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3220 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3221 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3222 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3223 hardware debouncing.
3224 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3225 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3226
3227 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3228 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3229 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3230 to use push/pull output drivers.
3231 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3232 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3233 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3234 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3235
3236 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3237 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3238 issues (not limited to errata).
3239 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3240 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3241 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3242 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3243 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3244 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3245 @end itemize
3246
3247 There can also be other issues.
3248 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3249 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3250 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3251 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3252 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3253 Agreement (NDA).
3254
3255 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3256 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3257 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3258
3259 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3260 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3261
3262 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3263
3264 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3265 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3266 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3267 allowing it to be deasserted.
3268 @end deffn
3269
3270 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3271 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3272 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3273 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3274 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3275 @end deffn
3276
3277 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3278 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3279 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3280 allowing it to be deasserted.
3281 @end deffn
3282
3283 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3284 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3285 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3286 @end deffn
3287
3288 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3289 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3290 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3291 configuration scripts.
3292
3293 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3294 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3295 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3296 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3297 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3298 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3299 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3300 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3301
3302 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3303 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3304 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3305 -- may be specified at a time.
3306 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3307 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3308 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3309 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3310 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3311
3312 @itemize
3313 @item
3314 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3315 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3316 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3317 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3318 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3319
3320 @quotation Tip
3321 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3322 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3323 @end quotation
3324
3325 @item
3326 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3327 signal implementations.
3328 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3329 indicating everything behaves normally.
3330 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3331 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3332 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3333 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3334 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3335 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3336 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3337
3338 @item
3339 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3340 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3341 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3342 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3343 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3344 while SRST is asserted.
3345 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3346 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3347
3348 @item
3349 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3350 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3351 is required to use this option.
3352 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3353 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3354 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3355 be asserted before any target connection.
3356 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3357 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3358 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3359 @end itemize
3360
3361 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3362 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3363 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3364 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3365 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3366
3367 @itemize
3368 @item
3369 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3370 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3371 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3372 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3373
3374 @item
3375 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3376 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3377 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3378 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3379 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3380 @end itemize
3381 @end deffn
3382
3383 @section Custom Reset Handling
3384 @cindex events
3385
3386 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3387 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3388 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3389 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3390 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3391 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3392
3393 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3394 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3395 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3396 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3397 want to reset everything at once.
3398
3399 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3400 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3401 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3402 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3403 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3404 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3405 needs special attention.
3406
3407 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3408 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3409 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3410 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3411 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3412 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3413 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3414 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3415
3416 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3417 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3418 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3419 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3420 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3421
3422 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3423 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3424 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3425 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3426 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3427 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3428 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3429 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3430 or potentially some other value.
3431
3432 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3433 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3434 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3435 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3436 (or their associated targets)
3437 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3438
3439 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3440 they return.
3441 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3442 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3443 @end deffn
3444
3445 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3446 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3447 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3448 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3449 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3450 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3451 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3452 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3453 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3454 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3455 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3456 @end deffn
3457
3458 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3459 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3460 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3461 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3462 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3463 @end deffn
3464
3465
3466 @node TAP Declaration
3467 @chapter TAP Declaration
3468 @cindex TAP declaration
3469 @cindex TAP configuration
3470
3471 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3472 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3473
3474 @itemize @bullet
3475 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3476 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3477 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3478 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3479 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3480 start running that code.
3481 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3482 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3483 and missing connections.
3484 @end itemize
3485
3486 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3487 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3488 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3489 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3490 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3491
3492 @section Scan Chains
3493 @cindex scan chain
3494
3495 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3496 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3497 They also need to be added to
3498 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3499 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3500 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3501 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3502 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3503 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3504 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3505 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3506
3507 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3508 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3509 command, presented in the next chapter.
3510 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3511 debugging targets.)
3512 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3513
3514 @verbatim
3515 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3516 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3517 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3518 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3519 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3520 @end verbatim
3521
3522 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3523 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3524 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3525 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3526 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3527 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3528 until they are told to do so.
3529
3530 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3531 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3532 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3533 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3534
3535 @example
3536 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3537 @end example
3538
3539 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3540 by a given chip.
3541 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3542 and so forth.
3543 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3544 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3545 both inside a single chip and between them.
3546 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3547
3548 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3549 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3550 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3551 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3552 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3553 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3554 includes commands something like this:
3555
3556 @example
3557 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3558 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3559 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3560 @end example
3561
3562 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3563 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3564 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3565
3566 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3567 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3568 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3569 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3570 @example
3571 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3572 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3573 @}
3574 @end example
3575 @end deffn
3576
3577 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3578 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3579 and their status.
3580 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3581 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3582 but systems with a JTAG router can
3583 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3584 @end deffn
3585
3586 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3587 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3588
3589 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3590 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3591
3592 @section TAP Names
3593 @cindex dotted name
3594
3595 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3596 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3597 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3598 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3599 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3600 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3601 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3602 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3603
3604 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3605 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3606 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3607
3608 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3609
3610 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3611 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3612 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3613 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3614
3615 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3616 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3617 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3618 overridable.
3619
3620 @cindex TAP naming convention
3621 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3622 and should follow this convention:
3623
3624 @itemize @bullet
3625 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3626 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3627 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3628 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3629 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3630 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3631 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3632 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3633 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3634 with a single TAP;
3635 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3636 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3637 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3638 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3639 @end itemize
3640
3641 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3642
3643 @itemize @bullet
3644 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3645 @*The length in bits of the
3646 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3647 @end itemize
3648
3649 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3650
3651 @itemize @bullet
3652 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3653 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3654 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3655 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3656 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3657 (the TAP is linked in).
3658 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3659 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3660 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3661 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3662 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3663 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3664 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3665 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3666 values that were found but not included in the list.
3667
3668 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3669 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3670 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3671 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3672 hardware to find these values.
3673 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3674 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3675 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3676 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3677 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3678 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3679 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3680 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3681 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3682 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3683 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3684 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3685 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3686 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3687 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3688 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3689 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3690 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3691 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3692 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3693 @end itemize
3694 @end deffn
3695
3696 @section Other TAP commands
3697
3698 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3699 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3700 At this writing this TAP attribute
3701 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3702 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3703 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3704 See the next section for information about the available events.
3705
3706 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3707 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3708 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3709 @end deffn
3710
3711 @section TAP Events
3712 @cindex events
3713 @cindex TAP events
3714
3715 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3716 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3717 The other applies to debugger targets,
3718 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3719
3720 The TAP events currently defined are:
3721
3722 @itemize @bullet
3723 @item @b{post-reset}
3724 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3725 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3726 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3727 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3728 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3729
3730 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3731 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3732 of any particular target.
3733 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3734 @item @b{setup}
3735 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3736 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3737 @item @b{tap-disable}
3738 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3739 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3740 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3741 @item @b{tap-enable}
3742 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3743 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3744 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3745 @end itemize
3746
3747 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3748 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3749 contents to be accurate), you might:
3750
3751 @example
3752 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3753 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3754 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3755 @}
3756 @end example
3757
3758
3759 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3760 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3761 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3762 @cindex jrc
3763
3764 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3765 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3766 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3767 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3768 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3769
3770 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3771 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3772 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3773 be visible.
3774 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3775 ignores, such as:
3776
3777 @itemize
3778 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3779 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3780 TAPs receive new instructions.
3781 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3782 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3783 @end itemize
3784
3785 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3786 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3787 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3788 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3789
3790 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3791 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3792
3793 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3794 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3795 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3796 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3797 should define TAP event handlers using
3798 code that looks something like this:
3799
3800 @example
3801 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3802 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3803 @}
3804 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3805 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3806 @}
3807 @end example
3808
3809 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3810
3811 @example
3812 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3813 @end example
3814
3815 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3816 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3817 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3818 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3819
3820 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3821 If necessary, disables the tap
3822 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3823 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3824 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3825 and "0" if it is disabled.
3826 @end deffn
3827
3828 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3829 If necessary, enables the tap
3830 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3831 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3832 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3833 and "0" if it is disabled.
3834 @end deffn
3835
3836 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3837 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3838 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3839 and "0" if it is disabled.
3840
3841 @quotation Note
3842 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3843 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3844 @end quotation
3845 @end deffn
3846
3847 @anchor{autoprobing}
3848 @section Autoprobing
3849 @cindex autoprobe
3850 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3851
3852 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3853 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3854 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3855 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3856
3857 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3858 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3859 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3860 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3861 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3862 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3863 right when they come out of reset).
3864
3865 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3866
3867 @example
3868 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3869 reset_config trst_and_srst
3870 jtag_rclk 8
3871 @end example
3872
3873 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3874 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3875
3876 @enumerate
3877 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3878 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3879 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3880 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3881 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3882 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3883 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3884 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3885 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3886 that is discovered.
3887 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3888 register, it will report it.
3889 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3890 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3891 @end enumerate
3892
3893 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3894 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3895 that's a bit more complex:
3896
3897 @example
3898 clock speed 8 kHz
3899 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3900 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3901 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3902 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3903 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3904 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3905 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3906 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3907 @end example
3908
3909 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3910 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3911 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3912 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3913 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3914 and so forth.
3915
3916 @node CPU Configuration
3917 @chapter CPU Configuration
3918 @cindex GDB target
3919
3920 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3921 You can also access these targets without GDB
3922 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3923 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3924 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3925 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3926
3927 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3928 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3929
3930 @section Target List
3931 @cindex target, current
3932 @cindex target, list
3933
3934 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3935 where each member has a name.
3936 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3937 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3938 (plural!) command.
3939 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3940 look like with more than one:
3941 @verbatim
3942 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3943 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3944 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3945 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3946 @end verbatim
3947
3948 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3949 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3950 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3951 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3952 space seen by that current target.
3953 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3954 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3955 are examples; and there are many more.
3956
3957 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3958
3959 @deffn Command {target current}
3960 Returns the name of the current target.
3961 @end deffn
3962
3963 @deffn Command {target names}
3964 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3965 @example
3966 foreach t [target names] @{
3967 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3968 @}
3969 @end example
3970 @end deffn
3971
3972 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3973 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3974
3975 @deffn Command targets [name]
3976 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3977 command names are singular.}
3978
3979 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3980 targets in a user friendly form.
3981
3982 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3983 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3984 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3985 @end deffn
3986
3987 @section Target CPU Types
3988 @cindex target type
3989 @cindex CPU type
3990
3991 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3992 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3993 when calling @command{target create}.
3994 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3995 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3996 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3997 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3998 what core-specific commands may be available
3999 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4000 and more.
4001
4002 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4003 since there's a command to list them.
4004
4005 @anchor{targettypes}
4006 @deffn Command {target types}
4007 Lists all supported target types.
4008 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4009
4010 @itemize @bullet
4011 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4012 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4013 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4014 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4015 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4016 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4017 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4018 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4019 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4020 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4021 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4022 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4023 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4024 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4025 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4026 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4027 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4028 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4029 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4030 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4031 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4032 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4033 @itemize @minus
4034 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4035 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4036 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4037 @end itemize
4038 And two debug interfaces cores:
4039 @itemize @minus
4040 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4041 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4042 @end itemize
4043 @end itemize
4044 @end deffn
4045
4046 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4047 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4048 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4049 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4050 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4051 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4052 reflect design generations;
4053 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4054 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4055
4056 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4057 @section Target Configuration
4058
4059 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4060 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4061 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4062 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4063 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4064
4065 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4066 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4067 optional parts.
4068 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4069 command, created as part of target creation.
4070
4071 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4072 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4073 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4074 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4075 to be much more board-specific.
4076 The key steps you use might look something like this
4077
4078 @example
4079 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4080 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4081 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4082 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4083 @end example
4084
4085 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4086 on-chip SRAM.
4087 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4088 writes to target memory;
4089 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4090 GDB memory checksumming;
4091 and more.
4092
4093 @quotation Warning
4094 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4095 inaccessible when application code
4096 (such as an operating system)
4097 enables or disables the MMU.
4098 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4099 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4100 easy access to other addresses needed.
4101 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4102 @end quotation
4103
4104 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4105 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4106 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4107 controllers.
4108 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4109 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4110 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4111
4112 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4113 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4114 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4115 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4116 purposes including additional configuration.
4117
4118 @itemize @bullet
4119 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4120 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4121 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4122 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4123
4124 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4125 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4126 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4127 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4128 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4129 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4130 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4131
4132 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4133 @end itemize
4134 @end deffn
4135
4136 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4137 The options accepted by this command may also be
4138 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4139 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4140 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4141
4142 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4143 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4144 and changing its endianness.
4145
4146 @itemize @bullet
4147
4148 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4149 used to access this target.
4150
4151 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4152 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4153
4154 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4155 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4156 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4157 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4158 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4159 same event name assigns only one handler.
4160
4161 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4162 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4163 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4164 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4165 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4166 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4167 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4168
4169 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4170 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4171 or virtual address is being used.
4172
4173 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4174 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4175
4176 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4177 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4178 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4179 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4180 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4181
4182 @anchor{rtostype}
4183 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4184 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4185 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4186 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4187
4188 @end itemize
4189 @end deffn
4190
4191 @section Other $target_name Commands
4192 @cindex object command
4193
4194 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4195 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4196
4197 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4198 Once a button is created a button
4199 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4200 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4201 configure it like this:
4202
4203 @example
4204 # Create
4205 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4206 # Modify
4207 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4208 # Query
4209 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4210 # Report
4211 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4212 @end example
4213
4214 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4215 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4216
4217 @example
4218 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4219 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4220 @end example
4221
4222 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4223
4224 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine}
4225 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4226 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4227 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4228 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4229 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4230 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4231 They are not otherwise documented here.
4232 @end deffn
4233
4234 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4235 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4236 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4237 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4238 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4239 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4240 the target side uses raw memory.
4241
4242 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4243 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4244 The script orientation comes from working with data
4245 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4246 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4247 and neither store nor return those values.
4248
4249 @itemize
4250 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4251 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4252 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4253 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4254 @end itemize
4255 @end deffn
4256
4257 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4258 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4259 @command{$target_name configure}
4260 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4261 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4262 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4263 There are a few special cases:
4264
4265 @itemize @bullet
4266 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4267 event named @var{event_name}.
4268 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4269 two parameters.
4270 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4271 This is a special case because this is set using
4272 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4273 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4274 @end itemize
4275
4276 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4277 all the targets you might use something like this:
4278
4279 @example
4280 foreach name [target names] @{
4281 set y [$name cget -endian]
4282 set z [$name cget -type]
4283 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4284 $x $name $y $z]
4285 @}
4286 @end example
4287 @end deffn
4288
4289 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4290 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4291 Displays the current target state:
4292 @code{debug-running},
4293 @code{halted},
4294 @code{reset},
4295 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4296 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4297 @end deffn
4298
4299 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4300 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4301 currently associated with this target.
4302 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4303 @end deffn
4304
4305 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4306 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4307 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4308 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4309 @end deffn
4310
4311 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4312 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4313 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4314 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4315 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4316 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4317 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4318 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4319 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4320 @end deffn
4321
4322 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4323 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4324 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4325 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4326 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4327 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @anchor{targetevents}
4331 @section Target Events
4332 @cindex target events
4333 @cindex events
4334 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4335 For example:
4336 @itemize @bullet
4337 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4338 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4339 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4340 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4341 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4342 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4343 to set up system clocks or
4344 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4345 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4346 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4347 @end itemize
4348
4349 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4350 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4351 @command{target create ... -event}.
4352
4353 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4354 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4355 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4356
4357 @example
4358 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4359 echo "Reset..."
4360 reset halt
4361 @}
4362 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4363 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4364 echo "Reset..."
4365 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4366 # we need a reset init.
4367 reset init
4368 @}
4369 @end example
4370
4371 The following target events are defined:
4372
4373 @itemize @bullet
4374 @item @b{debug-halted}
4375 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4376 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4377 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4378 @item @b{early-halted}
4379 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4380 @item @b{examine-start}
4381 @* Before target examine is called.
4382 @item @b{examine-end}
4383 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4384 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4385 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4386 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4387 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4388 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4389 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4390 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4391 @* When GDB disconnects
4392 @item @b{gdb-end}
4393 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4394 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4395 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4396 @code{reset init})
4397 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4398 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4399 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4400 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4401 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4402 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4403 @item @b{gdb-start}
4404 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4405 @item @b{halted}
4406 @* The target has halted
4407 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4408 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4409 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4410 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4411 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4412 @item @b{reset-assert}
4413 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4414 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4415 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4416 it instead of asserting SRST.
4417 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4418 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4419 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4420 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4421 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4422 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4423 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4424 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4425 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4426 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4427 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4428 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4429 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4430 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4431 released on the scan chain.
4432 @item @b{reset-end}
4433 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4434 @ignore
4435 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4436 @* Currently not used
4437 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4438 @* Currently not used
4439 @end ignore
4440 @item @b{reset-init}
4441 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4442 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4443
4444 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4445 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4446 multiplexing, and so on.
4447 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4448 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4449 @item @b{reset-start}
4450 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4451 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4452
4453 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4454 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4455 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4456 @ignore
4457 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4458 @* Currently not used
4459 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4460 @* Currently not used
4461 @end ignore
4462 @item @b{resume-start}
4463 @* Before any target is resumed
4464 @item @b{resume-end}
4465 @* After all targets have resumed
4466 @item @b{resumed}
4467 @* Target has resumed
4468 @item @b{trace-config}
4469 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4470 @end itemize
4471
4472 @node Flash Commands
4473 @chapter Flash Commands
4474
4475 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4476 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4477 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4478 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4479 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4480 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4481 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4482 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4483 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4484
4485 Flash Steps:
4486 @enumerate
4487 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4488 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4489 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4490 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4491 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4492 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4493 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4494 @item GDB Flashing
4495 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4496 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4497 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4498 @end enumerate
4499
4500 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4501 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4502 so that it can't boot.
4503 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4504 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4505
4506 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4507 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4508 @cindex flash configuration
4509
4510 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4511 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4512 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4513 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4514 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4515 see the driver-specific documentation.
4516
4517 @itemize @bullet
4518 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4519 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4520 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4521 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4522 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4523 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4524 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4525 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4526 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4527 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4528 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4529 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4530 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4531 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4532 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4533 commands to the flash controller.
4534 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4535 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4536 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4537 for more information.
4538 @end itemize
4539 @quotation Note
4540 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4541 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4542 @end quotation
4543 @end deffn
4544
4545 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4546 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4547 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4548 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4549 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4550 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4551 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4552 @end deffn
4553
4554 @deffn Command {flash list}
4555 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4556 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4557 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4558 @end deffn
4559
4560 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4561 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4562 depends on the flash type.
4563 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4564 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4565 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4566 but most don't bother.
4567 @end deffn
4568
4569 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4570 @cindex flash erasing
4571 @cindex flash reading
4572 @cindex flash writing
4573 @cindex flash programming
4574 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4575
4576 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4577 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4578 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4579 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4580 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4581
4582 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4583 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4584 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4585 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4586 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4587
4588 @quotation Note
4589 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4590 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4591 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4592 back to a flash bank.
4593 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4594 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4595 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4596 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4597 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4598 @end quotation
4599
4600 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4601 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4602 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4603 disabled first.
4604 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4605 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4606 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4607
4608 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4609 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4610 up to and including @var{last}.
4611 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4612 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4613 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4614 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4615 @end deffn
4616
4617 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4618 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4619 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4620 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4621 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4622 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4623 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4624 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4625 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4626 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4627 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4628 before erase starts.
4629 @end deffn
4630
4631 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4632 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4633 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4634 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4635 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4636 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4637 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4638 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4639 before issuing this command.
4640 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4641 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4642 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4643 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4644 @end deffn
4645 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4646
4647 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4648 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4649 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4650 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4651 @end deffn
4652
4653 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4654 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4655 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4656 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4657 @end deffn
4658
4659 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4660 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4661 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4662 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4663 @end deffn
4664
4665 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4666 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4667 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4668 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4669 to the base address for each section in the image.
4670 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4671 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4672 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4673 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4674 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4675 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4676 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4677 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4678 each image section.
4679
4680 @quotation Warning
4681 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4682 data you want to preserve.
4683 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4684 sections might be erased with no notice.
4685 @itemize
4686 @item
4687 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4688 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4689 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4690 @item
4691 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4692 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4693 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4694 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4695 @end itemize
4696 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4697 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4698 @end quotation
4699
4700 @end deffn
4701
4702 @section Other Flash commands
4703 @cindex flash protection
4704
4705 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4706 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4707 and display that status.
4708 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4709 @end deffn
4710
4711 @deffn Command {flash info} num
4712 Print info about flash bank @var{num}
4713 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4714 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4715 and possibly stale information.
4716 @end deffn
4717
4718 @anchor{flashprotect}
4719 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4720 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4721 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4722 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4723 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4724 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4725 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4726 @end deffn
4727
4728 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4729 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4730 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4731 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4732 @end deffn
4733
4734 @anchor{program}
4735 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4736 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4737 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4738 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4739 @end deffn
4740
4741 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4742 @section Flash Driver List
4743 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4744 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4745 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4746
4747 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4748 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4749 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4750
4751 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4752
4753 @itemize
4754 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4755 @end itemize
4756
4757 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4758 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4759 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4760 @example
4761 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4762 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4763 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4764 @end example
4765 @end deffn
4766
4767 @subsection External Flash
4768
4769 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4770 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4771 @cindex CFI
4772 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4773 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4774 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4775 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4776 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4777 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4778 configure a bus and its timings), or
4779 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4780 on the flash chip.
4781 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4782 speed up operation.
4783
4784 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4785
4786 @itemize
4787 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4788 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4789 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4790 @end itemize
4791
4792 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4793 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4794
4795 @example
4796 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4797 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4798 @end example
4799
4800 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4801 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4802 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4803
4804 @example
4805 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4806 @end example
4807
4808 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4809 @end deffn
4810
4811 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4812 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4813 @cindex SPI
4814 @cindex jtagspi
4815 @cindex bscan_spi
4816 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4817 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4818 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4819 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4820 accessed through JTAG.
4821
4822 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4823 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4824 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4825 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4826 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4827 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4828
4829 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4830 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4831 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4832 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4833 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4834 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4835 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4836 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4837
4838 @itemize
4839 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4840 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4841 @var{USER1} instruction.
4842 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4843 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4844 @end itemize
4845
4846 @example
4847 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4848 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4849 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4850 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4851 @end example
4852 @end deffn
4853
4854 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4855 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4856 @cindex SPIFI
4857 @cindex lpcspifi
4858 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4859 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4860 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4861
4862 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4863 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4864 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4865 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4866 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4867
4868 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4869 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4870 are configured by the driver.
4871
4872 @example
4873 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4874 @end example
4875
4876 @end deffn
4877
4878 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4879 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4880 @cindex SMI
4881 @cindex stmsmi
4882 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4883 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4884 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4885 SPI flash devices.
4886 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4887 flash devices can be connected.
4888
4889 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4890 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4891 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4892 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4893 the flash content.
4894
4895 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4896 to identify the memory bank.
4897 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4898 flash size, are detected automatically.
4899
4900 @example
4901 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4902 @end example
4903
4904 @end deffn
4905
4906 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4907 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4908 Microcontroller platform.
4909
4910 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4911 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4912
4913 @example
4914 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4915 @end example
4916
4917 @end deffn
4918
4919 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4920
4921 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4922 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4923 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4924 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4925 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4926 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4927
4928 @example
4929 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4930 @end example
4931 @end deffn
4932
4933 @anchor{at91samd}
4934 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4935 @cindex at91samd
4936
4937 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4938 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4939 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4940 processor to be halted.
4941 @end deffn
4942
4943 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4944 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4945 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4946 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4947 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4948 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4949
4950 @example
4951 at91samd set-security enable
4952 @end example
4953 @end deffn
4954
4955 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4956 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4957 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4958 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4959 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4960 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4961 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4962 in order to disable this feature.
4963
4964 @example
4965 at91samd eeprom
4966 at91samd eeprom 1024
4967 @end example
4968 @end deffn
4969
4970 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4971 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4972 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4973 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4974 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4975 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4976
4977 @example
4978 at91samd bootloader
4979 at91samd bootloader 16384
4980 @end example
4981 @end deffn
4982
4983 @end deffn
4984
4985 @anchor{at91sam3}
4986 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
4987 @cindex at91sam3
4988 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
4989 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
4990 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
4991 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
4992 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
4993 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
4994 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
4995 chips are confirmed.}
4996
4997 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
4998 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
4999 the following fixed locations:
5000
5001 @example
5002 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5003 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5004 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5005 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5006 @end example
5007
5008 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5009 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5010 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5011
5012 @itemize
5013 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5014 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5015 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5016 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5017 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5018 @end itemize
5019
5020 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5021
5022 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5023 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5024 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5025 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5026 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5027 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5028 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5029
5030 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5031 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5032 @end deffn
5033
5034 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5035 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5036 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5037 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5038 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5039 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5040 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5041 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5042 @end deffn
5043
5044 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5045 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5046 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5047 @end deffn
5048 @end deffn
5049
5050 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5051 @cindex at91sam4
5052 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5053 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5054 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5055 @end deffn
5056
5057 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5058 @cindex at91sam4l
5059 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5060 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5061 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5062
5063 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5064 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5065 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5066 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5067 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5068 @end deffn
5069 @end deffn
5070
5071 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5072 @cindex atsamv
5073 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5074 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5075 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5076 @end deffn
5077
5078 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5079 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5080 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5081 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5082 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5083
5084 @example
5085 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5086 @end example
5087
5088 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5089 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5090
5091 @itemize
5092 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5093 @item @var{banks}
5094 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5095 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5096 @item @var{pages_size}
5097 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5098 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5099 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5100 @end itemize
5101
5102 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5103 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5104 will be autoconfigured.
5105 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5106
5107 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5108 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5109 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5110 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5111 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5112
5113 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5114 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5115 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5116 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5117 are not truly general purpose).
5118 @quotation Note
5119 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5120 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5121 @end quotation
5122 @end deffn
5123 @end deffn
5124
5125 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5126 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5127 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5128 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5129 @end deffn
5130
5131 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5132 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5133 internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5134 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5135 autoconfigures itself.
5136 @example
5137 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5138 @end example
5139 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5140 supported.}
5141 @end deffn
5142
5143 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5144 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5145 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores.
5146 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5147 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5148 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5149 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5150
5151 @example
5152 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5153 @end example
5154 @end deffn
5155
5156 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5157 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5158 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5159 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5160 microcontroller families from NXP.
5161
5162 @quotation Note
5163 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5164 driver:
5165 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5166 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5167 @end quotation
5168
5169 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5170 which must appear in the following order:
5171
5172 @itemize
5173 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5174 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5175 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5176 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5177 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5178 LPC43x[2357])
5179 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5180 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5181 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5182 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5183 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5184 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5185 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5186 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5187 at which the core is running
5188 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5189 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5190 @quotation Note
5191 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5192 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5193 However, if you do provide it,
5194 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5195 @end quotation
5196 @end itemize
5197
5198 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5199
5200 @example
5201 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5202 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5203 @end example
5204
5205 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5206 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5207 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5208 @end deffn
5209 @end deffn
5210
5211 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5212 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5213 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5214 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5215 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5216 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5217
5218 @example
5219 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5220 @end example
5221 @end deffn
5222
5223 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5224 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5225 from NXP.
5226
5227 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5228 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5229 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5230 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5231 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5232 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5233 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5234 you start the PLL.
5235
5236 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5237
5238 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5239 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5240 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5241
5242 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5243 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5244 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5245 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5246 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5247 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5248 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5249
5250 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5251 @example
5252 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5253 @end example
5254
5255 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5256 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5257 @code{flash banks} command.
5258
5259 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5260 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5261 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5262 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5263 a known signature.
5264 Example:
5265 @example
5266 lpc2900 signature 0
5267 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5268 @end example
5269 @end deffn
5270
5271 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5272 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5273 saves it to a file in binary format.
5274 Example:
5275 @example
5276 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5277 @end example
5278 @end deffn
5279
5280 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5281 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5282 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5283 command:
5284
5285 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5286 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5287 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5288 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5289
5290 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5291 Example:
5292 @example
5293 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5294 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5295 @end example
5296 @end deffn
5297
5298 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5299 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5300 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5301 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5302 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5303 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5304 912 bytes.
5305 @quotation Attention
5306 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5307 @end quotation
5308 Example:
5309 @example
5310 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5311 @end example
5312 @end deffn
5313
5314 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5315 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5316 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5317 after the next power cycle.
5318 @quotation Attention
5319 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5320 @end quotation
5321 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5322 Example:
5323 @example
5324 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5325 flash info 0
5326 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5327 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5328 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5329 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5330 @end example
5331 @end deffn
5332
5333 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5334 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5335 effective after the next power cycle.
5336 @quotation Attention
5337 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5338 @end quotation
5339 Examples:
5340 @example
5341 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5342 @end example
5343 @end deffn
5344 @end deffn
5345
5346 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5347 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5348 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5349 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5350
5351 @example
5352 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5353 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5354 @end example
5355
5356 @itemize @bullet
5357 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5358 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5359 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5360 @end itemize
5361
5362 Example usage:
5363 @example
5364 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5365 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5366 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5367 @} else @{
5368 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5369 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5370 @}
5371 @end example
5372 @end deffn
5373
5374 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5375 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5376 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5377
5378 @example
5379 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5380 @end example
5381
5382 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5383
5384 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5385 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5386 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5387 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5388 code.
5389 @end deffn
5390
5391 @end deffn
5392
5393 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5394 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5395 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5396
5397 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5398 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5399 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5400 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5401
5402 @example
5403 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5404 @end example
5405 @end deffn
5406
5407 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5408 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5409 and integrate flash memory.
5410
5411 @example
5412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5413 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5414 @end example
5415
5416 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5417 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5418 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5419 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5420 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5421 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5422 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5423 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5424 @end deffn
5425 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5426 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5427 This will remove any Code Protection.
5428 @end deffn
5429 @end deffn
5430
5431 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5432 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5433 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M0 cores.
5434 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5435 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5436
5437 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5438 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5439
5440 @example
5441 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5442 @end example
5443
5444 psoc4-specific commands
5445 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5446 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5447
5448 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5449 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5450
5451 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5452 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5453 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5454
5455 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5456 @end deffn
5457
5458 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5459 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5460
5461 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5462 @end deffn
5463 @end deffn
5464
5465 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5466 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5467 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5468 and SWD interface.
5469 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5470 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5471
5472 @example
5473 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5474 @end example
5475
5476 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5477
5478 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5479 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5480 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5481 @end deffn
5482
5483 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5484 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5485 @end deffn
5486 @end deffn
5487
5488 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5489 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5490 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5491 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5492 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5493 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5494 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5495 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5496
5497 @example
5498 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5499 @end example
5500
5501 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5502 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5503 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5504 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5505 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5506 disabled.
5507
5508 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5509 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5510 @quotation Warning
5511 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5512 applied to all of them.
5513 @end quotation
5514 @end deffn
5515 @end deffn
5516
5517 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5518 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5519 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5520 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5521 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5522
5523 @example
5524 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5525 @end example
5526
5527 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5528 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5529 the flash driver.
5530
5531 @example
5532 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5533 @end example
5534
5535 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5536 as per the following example.
5537 @example
5538 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5539 @end example
5540
5541 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5542 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5543 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5544 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5545 are defined:
5546
5547 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5548 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5549 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5550 @end deffn
5551
5552 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5553 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5554 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5555 @end deffn
5556
5557 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5558 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5559 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5560 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5561 @end deffn
5562
5563 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5564 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5565 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5566 @end deffn
5567 @end deffn
5568
5569 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5570 All members of the STM32F2 and STM32F4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5571 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4 cores.
5572 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5573 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5574
5575 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5576 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5577 the flash driver.
5578
5579 @example
5580 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5581 @end example
5582
5583 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5584
5585 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5586 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5587 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5588 @end deffn
5589
5590 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5591 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5592 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5593 @end deffn
5594 @end deffn
5595
5596 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5597 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5598 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5599 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5600 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5601
5602 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5603 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5604 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5605 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5606 second bank.
5607
5608 @example
5609 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5610 @end example
5611
5612 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5613
5614 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5615 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5616 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5617 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5618 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5619 @end deffn
5620 @end deffn
5621
5622 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5623 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5624 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5625 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5626 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5627
5628 @example
5629 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5630 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5631 @end example
5632
5633 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5634 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5635 for the specified flash bank.
5636 @end deffn
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5640 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5641 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5642 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5643 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5644
5645 @example
5646 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5647 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5648 @end example
5649
5650 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5651 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5652 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5653
5654 @itemize @bullet
5655 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5656 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5657 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5658 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5659 @end itemize
5660 @end deffn
5661
5662 @end deffn
5663
5664 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5665 @cindex str9xpec
5666
5667 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5668 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5669 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5670 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5671
5672 Here is some background info to help
5673 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5674 the str9:
5675 @enumerate
5676 @item
5677 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5678 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5679 @item
5680 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5681 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5682 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5683 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5684 @end enumerate
5685
5686 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5687 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5688 configured for flash bank 0.
5689 @example
5690 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5691 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5692 jtag_reset 0 1
5693 # turn off target polling
5694 poll off
5695 # disable str9 core
5696 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5697 # read option bytes
5698 str9xpec options_read 0
5699 # re-enable str9 core
5700 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5701 poll on
5702 reset halt
5703 @end example
5704 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5705 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5706 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5707 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5708
5709 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5710
5711 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5712 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5713 @end deffn
5714
5715 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5716 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5717 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5718 @end deffn
5719
5720 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5721 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5722 erase the device.
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5726 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5727 @end deffn
5728
5729 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5730 Configure str9 boot bank.
5731 @end deffn
5732
5733 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5734 Configure str9 lvd source.
5735 @end deffn
5736
5737 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5738 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5739 @end deffn
5740
5741 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5742 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5743 @end deffn
5744
5745 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5746 Read str9 option bytes.
5747 @end deffn
5748
5749 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5750 Write str9 option bytes.
5751 @end deffn
5752
5753 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5754 unlock str9 device.
5755 @end deffn
5756
5757 @end deffn
5758
5759 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5760 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5761 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5762 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5763
5764 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5765
5766 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5767 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5768 @end deffn
5769
5770 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5771 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5772 @end deffn
5773
5774 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5775 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5776 the flash clock.
5777 @end deffn
5778 @end deffn
5779
5780 @section NAND Flash Commands
5781 @cindex NAND
5782
5783 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
5784 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
5785 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
5786
5787 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
5788 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
5789 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
5790 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
5791 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
5792 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
5793
5794 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
5795 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
5796 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
5797 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
5798 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
5799 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
5800 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
5801 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
5802 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
5803 with techniques such as wear leveling.
5804
5805 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
5806 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
5807 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
5808 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
5809 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
5810 every 512 bytes of data.
5811
5812 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
5813 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
5814 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
5815 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
5816 ECC mode is used.
5817
5818 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
5819 @enumerate
5820 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
5821 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5822 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
5823 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
5824 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
5825 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
5826 to access that device.
5827 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
5828 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5829 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
5830 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
5831 de-brick a board.
5832 @end enumerate
5833
5834 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
5835 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
5836 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
5837 are only 32 bits wide.
5838 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
5839 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
5840 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
5841 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
5842
5843 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
5844 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
5845 @cindex NAND configuration
5846
5847 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
5848 plus some additional configuration that's done after
5849 OpenOCD has initialized.
5850
5851 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
5852 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
5853 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
5854 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
5855 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
5856 they were a single (larger) device.
5857 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
5858 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
5859
5860 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
5861 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
5862 configuration files, not interactively.
5863
5864 @itemize @bullet
5865 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
5866 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
5867 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
5868 associated with the NAND device being declared.
5869 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
5870 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
5871 commands to the NAND controller.
5872 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5873 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
5874 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
5875 for more information.
5876 @end itemize
5877 @end deffn
5878
5879 @deffn Command {nand list}
5880 Prints a summary of each device declared
5881 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
5882 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
5883 @example
5884 > nand list
5885 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5886 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5887 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
5888 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
5889 >
5890 @end example
5891 @end deffn
5892
5893 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
5894 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
5895 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
5896 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5897 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
5898 it with most other NAND commands.
5899 @end deffn
5900
5901 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
5902
5903 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
5904 @cindex NAND reading
5905 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
5906 starting at the specified offset.
5907 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5908
5909 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5910 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5911
5912 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
5913 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
5914 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
5915
5916 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
5917 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
5918 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
5919 method which handled that error correction.
5920
5921 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
5922 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
5923 @itemize @bullet
5924 @item no oob_* parameter
5925 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
5926 @item @code{oob_raw}
5927 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
5928 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
5929 spare areas associated with each data page.
5930 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
5931 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
5932 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
5933 @item @code{oob_only}
5934 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
5935 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
5936 spare areas associated with each data page.
5937 @end itemize
5938 @end deffn
5939
5940 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
5941 @cindex NAND erasing
5942 @cindex NAND programming
5943 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
5944 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
5945 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
5946 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
5947 If those parameters are not specified,
5948 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
5949 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5950
5951 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
5952 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
5953 block marker.
5954 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
5955 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
5956 @end deffn
5957
5958 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
5959 @cindex NAND writing
5960 @cindex NAND programming
5961 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
5962 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
5963 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
5964 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
5965
5966 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
5967 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
5968
5969 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
5970 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
5971 past the end of the device.
5972 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
5973 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
5974 if that's being written.)
5975
5976 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
5977 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
5978 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
5979
5980 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
5981 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
5982 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
5983 @itemize @bullet
5984 @item no oob_* parameter
5985 @*File has only page data, which is written.
5986 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
5987 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
5988 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
5989 with hardware-computed ECC data.
5990 @item @code{oob_only}
5991 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
5992 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
5993 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
5994 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
5995 @item @code{oob_raw}
5996 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
5997 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
5998 un-altered OOB.
5999 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6000 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6001 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6002 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6003 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6004 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6005 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6006 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6007 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6008 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6009 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6010 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6011 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6012 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6013 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6014 @end itemize
6015 @end deffn
6016
6017 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6018 @cindex NAND verification
6019 @cindex NAND programming
6020 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6021 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6022 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6023
6024 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6025 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6026
6027 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6028 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6029 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6030 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6031 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6032
6033 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6034 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6035 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6036
6037 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6038 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6039 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6040 be removed in a future release.
6041 @end deffn
6042
6043 @subsection Other NAND commands
6044 @cindex NAND other commands
6045
6046 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6047 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6048 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6049 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6050 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6051 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6052 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6053 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6054
6055 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6056 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6057 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6058 @end deffn
6059
6060 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6061 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6062 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6063 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6064 status for each block.
6065 @end deffn
6066
6067 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6068 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6069 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6070
6071 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6072 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6073 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6074 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6075 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6076
6077 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6078 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6079 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6080 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6081 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6082 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6083 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6084 @end deffn
6085
6086 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6087 @subsection NAND Driver List
6088 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6089 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6090 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6091
6092 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6093 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6094 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6095 address of the ECC controller.
6096 @example
6097 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6098 @end example
6099 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6100 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6101 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6102 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6103 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6104 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6105 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6106 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6107 @end deffn
6108 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6109 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6110 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6111 @end deffn
6112
6113 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6114 properly configured for input or output.
6115 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6116 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6117 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6118 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6119 @end deffn
6120 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6121 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6122 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6123 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6124 @end deffn
6125 @end deffn
6126
6127 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6128 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6129 chips from Texas Instruments.
6130 It takes three extra parameters:
6131 address of the NAND chip;
6132 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6133 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6134 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6135 @example
6136 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6137 @end example
6138 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6139 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6140 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6141 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6142 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6143 @end deffn
6144
6145 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6146 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6147 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6148 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6149 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6150 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6151 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6152 @end deffn
6153
6154 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6155 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6156 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6157 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6158 @end deffn
6159 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6160
6161 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6162 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6163 should work for this chip aswell.
6164 @end deffn
6165
6166 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6167 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6168 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6169 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6170 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6171 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6172 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6173 @example
6174 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6175 @end example
6176 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6177 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6178 without parameter query status.
6179 @end deffn
6180 @end deffn
6181
6182 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6183 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6184 parameter: the address of the controller.
6185 @example
6186 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6187 @end example
6188 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6189 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6190 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6191 change any behavior.
6192 @end deffn
6193
6194 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6195 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6196 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6197 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6198 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6199 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6200 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6201 specialized commands.
6202 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6203 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6204 change any behavior.
6205 @end deffn
6206
6207 @section mFlash
6208
6209 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6210 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6211
6212 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6213 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6214 address @var{base}.
6215 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6216 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6217
6218 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6219
6220 @example
6221 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6222 @end example
6223
6224 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6225
6226 @example
6227 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6228 @end example
6229 @end deffn
6230
6231 @subsection mFlash commands
6232 @cindex mFlash commands
6233
6234 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6235 Configure mflash PLL.
6236 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6237 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6238 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6239 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6240 @end deffn
6241
6242 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6243 Configure bootable option.
6244 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6245 (4kB) for boot.
6246 @end deffn
6247
6248 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6249 Configure storage information.
6250 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6251 written.
6252 @end deffn
6253
6254 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6255 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6256 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6257 @end deffn
6258
6259 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6260 Probe mflash.
6261 @end deffn
6262
6263 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6264 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6265 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6266 @end deffn
6267
6268 @node Flash Programming
6269 @chapter Flash Programming
6270
6271 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6272 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6273 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6274
6275 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6276 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6277
6278 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6279 @enumerate
6280 @item 'init' is executed.
6281 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6282 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6283 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6284 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6285 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6286 @end enumerate
6287
6288 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6289
6290 @example
6291 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6292 # are optional parameters
6293 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6294 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6295
6296 # binary files need the flash address passing
6297 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6298 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6299 @end example
6300
6301 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6302 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6303 @cindex PLD
6304 @cindex FPGA
6305
6306 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6307 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6308 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6309 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6310 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6311 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6312 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6313
6314 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6315
6316 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6317 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6318 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6319
6320 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6321 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6322
6323 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6324 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6325 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6326 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6327 behavior.
6328 @end deffn
6329
6330 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6331 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6332 @end deffn
6333
6334 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6335 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6336 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6337 @end deffn
6338
6339 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6340
6341 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6342 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6343 that particular type of PLD.
6344
6345 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6346 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6347 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6348
6349 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6350 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6351 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6352
6353 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6354 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6355 for FPGA @var{num}.
6356 @end deffn
6357 @end deffn
6358
6359 @node General Commands
6360 @chapter General Commands
6361 @cindex commands
6362
6363 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6364 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6365 commands are documented elsewhere.
6366
6367 Intent:
6368 @itemize @bullet
6369 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6370 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6371 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6372 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6373
6374 @item @b{From the human}
6375 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6376 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6377
6378 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6379 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6380 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6381
6382 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6383 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6384 port is 5555.
6385 @end itemize
6386
6387
6388 @section Daemon Commands
6389
6390 @deffn {Command} exit
6391 Exits the current telnet session.
6392 @end deffn
6393
6394 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6395 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6396 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6397 Not every command provides helptext.
6398
6399 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6400 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6401 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6402 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6403 @end deffn
6404
6405 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6406 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6407 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6408 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6409 Useful in connection with script files
6410 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6411 @end deffn
6412
6413 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6414 Close the OpenOCD daemon, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6415 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6416 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6417 @end deffn
6418
6419 @anchor{debuglevel}
6420 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6421 @cindex message level
6422 Display debug level.
6423 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6424 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6425 Level 0 is error messages only;
6426 level 1 adds warnings;
6427 level 2 adds informational messages;
6428 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6429 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6430 the command line along with the location of that log
6431 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6432 @xref{Running}.
6433 @end deffn
6434
6435 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6436 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6437 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6438 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6439 @example
6440 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6441 @end example
6442 @end deffn
6443
6444 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6445 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6446 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6447 @end deffn
6448
6449 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6450 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6451 @end deffn
6452
6453 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6454 @section Target State handling
6455 @cindex reset
6456 @cindex halt
6457 @cindex target initialization
6458
6459 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6460 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6461 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6462 a current target which is used to perform the
6463 various operations. The current target may be changed
6464 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6465 target which should become current.
6466
6467 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6468 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6469 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6470 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6471 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6472
6473 @emph{With no arguments}:
6474 list all available registers for the current target,
6475 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6476 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6477 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6478 are flagged as such.
6479
6480 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6481 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6482 bypassing any internal cache.
6483
6484 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6485 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6486 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6487 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6488 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6489 relevant module will flush such values.
6490
6491 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6492 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6493
6494 @example
6495 > reg
6496 ===== ARM registers
6497 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6498 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6499 (2) r2 (/32)
6500 ...
6501 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6502 >
6503 @end example
6504 @end deffn
6505
6506 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6507 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6508 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6509 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6510 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6511 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6512 (and enter debug mode).
6513 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6514
6515 @quotation Warning
6516 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6517 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6518 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6519 power mode by gating the core clock;
6520 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6521
6522 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6523 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6524 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6525 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6526 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6527 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6528
6529 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6530 work with a JTAG debugger.
6531 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6532 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6533 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6534 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6535 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6536 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6537 @end quotation
6538
6539 @end deffn
6540
6541 @deffn Command resume [address]
6542 Resume the target at its current code position,
6543 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6544 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6545 @end deffn
6546
6547 @deffn Command step [address]
6548 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6549 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6550 @end deffn
6551
6552 @anchor{resetcommand}
6553 @deffn Command reset
6554 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6555 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6556 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6557 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6558 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6559 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6560
6561 The optional parameter specifies what should
6562 happen after the reset.
6563 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6564 The other options will not work on all systems.
6565 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6566
6567 @itemize @minus
6568 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6569 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6570 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6571 @end itemize
6572 @end deffn
6573
6574 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6575 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6576 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6577 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6578 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6579 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6580 state.
6581 @end deffn
6582
6583 @section I/O Utilities
6584
6585 These commands are available when
6586 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6587 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6588 notably the ZY1000.
6589 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6590
6591 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6592
6593 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6594 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6595 the text file @file{filename}.
6596 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6597 The last string is followed by a newline.
6598 @end deffn
6599
6600 @deffn Command cat filename
6601 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6602 @end deffn
6603
6604 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6605 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6606 into @file{dest_filename}.
6607 @end deffn
6608
6609 @deffn Command ip
6610 @emph{No description provided.}
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @deffn Command ls
6614 @emph{No description provided.}
6615 @end deffn
6616
6617 @deffn Command mac
6618 @emph{No description provided.}
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn Command meminfo
6622 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6623 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6624 @end deffn
6625
6626 @deffn Command peek
6627 @emph{No description provided.}
6628 @end deffn
6629
6630 @deffn Command poke
6631 @emph{No description provided.}
6632 @end deffn
6633
6634 @deffn Command rm filename
6635 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6636 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6637 @end deffn
6638
6639 @deffn Command trunc filename
6640 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6641 @end deffn
6642
6643 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6644 @section Memory access commands
6645 @cindex memory access
6646
6647 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6648 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6649 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6650 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6651
6652 @enumerate
6653 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6654 to change the current target.
6655 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6656 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6657 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6658 @end enumerate
6659
6660 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6661 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6662 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6663 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6664 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6665 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6666 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6667 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6668 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6669 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6670 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6671 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6672 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6673 @end deffn
6674
6675 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6676 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6677 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6678 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6679 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6680 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6681 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6682 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6683 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6684 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6685 @end deffn
6686
6687 @anchor{imageaccess}
6688 @section Image loading commands
6689 @cindex image loading
6690 @cindex image dumping
6691
6692 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6693 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6694 binary file named @var{filename}.
6695 @end deffn
6696
6697 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6698 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6699 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6700 @end deffn
6701
6702 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6703 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6704 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6705 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6706 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6707 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6708 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6709 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6710 separately.
6711 @end deffn
6712
6713 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6714 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6715 The file format may optionally be specified
6716 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6717 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6718 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6719 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6720 @example
6721 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6722 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6723 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6724 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6725 $address $length
6726 @}
6727 @end example
6728 @end deffn
6729
6730 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6731 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6732 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6733 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6734 The file format may optionally be specified
6735 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6736 @end deffn
6737
6738 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6739 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6740 The file format may optionally be specified
6741 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6742 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6743 @end deffn
6744
6745
6746 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6747 @cindex breakpoint
6748 @cindex watchpoint
6749
6750 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6751 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6752 watchpoints.
6753 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6754
6755 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6756 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6757 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
6758 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6759 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
6760 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
6761
6762 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
6763 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
6764 @end deffn
6765
6766 @deffn Command {rbp} address
6767 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
6768 @end deffn
6769
6770 @deffn Command {rwp} address
6771 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
6772 @end deffn
6773
6774 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
6775 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
6776 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
6777 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
6778 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
6779 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
6780 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
6781 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
6782 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
6783 @end deffn
6784
6785 @section Misc Commands
6786
6787 @cindex profiling
6788 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
6789 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
6790 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
6791 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
6792 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
6793 limit the address range.
6794 @end deffn
6795
6796 @deffn Command {version}
6797 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
6798 @end deffn
6799
6800 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
6801 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
6802 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @node Architecture and Core Commands
6806 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
6807 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
6808 @cindex Core Specific Commands
6809
6810 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
6811 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
6812 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
6813 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
6814
6815 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
6816 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
6817 @cindex tracing
6818 @cindex ETM
6819 @cindex ETB
6820
6821 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
6822 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
6823 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
6824
6825 @itemize
6826 @item
6827 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
6828 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
6829 supports such an interface.
6830 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
6831 and trace port support.)
6832 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
6833 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
6834 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
6835 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
6836 in the board-specific configuration file.
6837 @item
6838 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
6839 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
6840 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
6841 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
6842 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
6843 @end itemize
6844
6845 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
6846
6847 @quotation Issues
6848 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
6849 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
6850
6851 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
6852 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
6853 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
6854 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
6855 dummy trace port driver}.
6856
6857 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
6858 as well as tracing only during specific states
6859 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
6860
6861 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
6862 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
6863 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
6864 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
6865 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
6866
6867 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
6868 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
6869 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
6870 this original style of JTAG access.
6871 @end quotation
6872
6873 @subsection ETM Configuration
6874 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
6875
6876 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
6877 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
6878 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
6879
6880 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
6881 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
6882 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
6883 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
6884 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
6885 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
6886 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
6887 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
6888 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
6889
6890 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
6891 or @option{demultiplexed}.
6892 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
6893
6894 @quotation Warning
6895 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
6896 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
6897 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
6898 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
6899 @end quotation
6900
6901 @quotation Note
6902 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
6903 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
6904 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
6905 what CPU activities are traced.
6906 @end quotation
6907 @end deffn
6908
6909 @deffn Command {etm info}
6910 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
6911 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
6912 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
6913 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
6914 @end deffn
6915
6916 @deffn Command {etm status}
6917 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
6918 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
6919 Did trace data overflow?
6920 Was it triggered?
6921 @end deffn
6922
6923 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
6924 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
6925 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
6926 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
6927 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
6928
6929 @itemize
6930 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
6931 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
6932 The value is one of
6933 @option{none} (save nothing),
6934 @option{data} (save data),
6935 @option{address} (save addresses),
6936 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
6937 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
6938 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
6939 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
6940 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
6941 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
6942 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
6943 trace stream without an image of the code.
6944 @end itemize
6945 @end deffn
6946
6947 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6948 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
6949 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
6950 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
6951 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
6952
6953 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
6954 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
6955 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
6956 @end deffn
6957
6958 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
6959
6960 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
6961 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
6962 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
6963
6964 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
6965 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
6966 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
6967 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
6968 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
6969 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
6970 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
6971
6972 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
6973
6974 @itemize
6975 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
6976 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
6977 for instruction access within that function's body.
6978 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
6979 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
6980 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
6981 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
6982 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
6983 combining one of the above models with a counter.
6984 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
6985 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
6986 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
6987 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
6988 @item @emph{... more}
6989 @end itemize
6990
6991 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
6992 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
6993
6994 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
6995 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
6996 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
6997 @end deffn
6998
6999 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7000 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7001 @end deffn
7002
7003 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7004 Opens an image file.
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7008 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7009 @end deffn
7010
7011 @deffn Command {etm start}
7012 Starts trace data collection.
7013 @end deffn
7014
7015 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7016 Stops trace data collection.
7017 @end deffn
7018
7019 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7020 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7021
7022 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7023
7024 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7025 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7026 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7027 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7028 any trace data collection.}
7029 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7030 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7031 @end deffn
7032 @end deffn
7033
7034 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7035 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7036 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7037 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7038 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7039 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7040 @end deffn
7041 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7042 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7043 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7044 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7045 trace trigger becomes active.
7046
7047 @itemize
7048 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7049 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7050 afterwards.
7051 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7052 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7053 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7054 what caused that event to happen.
7055 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7056 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7057 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7058 how the event caused trouble.
7059 @end itemize
7060 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7066 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7067 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7068 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7069 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7070
7071 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7072 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7073
7074 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7075 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7076 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7077 @end deffn
7078
7079 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7080 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7081 @end deffn
7082
7083 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7084 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7085 @end deffn
7086 @end deffn
7087
7088
7089 @section Generic ARM
7090 @cindex ARM
7091
7092 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7093 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7094 commands that may be available.
7095
7096 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7097 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7098 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7099 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7100 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7101 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7105 @cindex disassemble
7106 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7107 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7108 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7109 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7110 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7111 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7112 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7113
7114 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7115 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7116 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7117 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7118 with a handful of exceptions.
7119 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7120 @end deffn
7121
7122 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7123 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7124 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7125 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7126 and using the MCR instruction.
7127 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7128 an ARM register.)
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7132 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7133 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7134 and the MRC instruction.
7135 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7136 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7137 an ARM register.)
7138 @end deffn
7139
7140 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7141 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7142 core mode if necessary.
7143 @end deffn
7144
7145 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7146 @cindex ARM semihosting
7147 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7148
7149 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7150 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7151 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7152 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7153 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7154 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7155 @end deffn
7156
7157 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7158 @cindex ARMv4
7159 @cindex ARMv5
7160
7161 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7162 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7163 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7164 variant.
7165
7166 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7167 @cindex ARM7
7168 @cindex ARM9
7169
7170 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7171 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7172 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7173 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7174
7175 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7176 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7177 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7178 instead of breakpoints.
7179 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7180
7181 This should be
7182 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7183 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7184 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7185 @end deffn
7186
7187 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7188 @cindex DCC
7189 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7190 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7191 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7192
7193 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7194 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7195 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7196 @end deffn
7197
7198 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7199 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7200 that don't check completion of the operation.
7201 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7202
7203 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7204 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7205 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7206 @end deffn
7207
7208 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7209 @cindex ARM720T
7210
7211 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7212 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7213 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7214 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7215
7216 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7217 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7218 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7219
7220 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7221 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7222 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7223 @end deffn
7224
7225 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7226 @cindex ARM9
7227
7228 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7229 integer processors.
7230 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7231
7232 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7233 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7234 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7235 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7236
7237 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7238 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7239 @cindex vector_catch
7240 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7241 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7242 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7243 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7244 to those hardware vectors.
7245
7246 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7247 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7248 vector catch hardware to intercept
7249 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7250 @option{none} of them,
7251 or a list with one or more of the following:
7252 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7253 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7254 @end deffn
7255
7256 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7257 @cindex ARM920T
7258
7259 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7260 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7261 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7262 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7263 and ARM9 commands.
7264
7265 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7266 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7267 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7271 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7272 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7273 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7274 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7275 (Not all registers can be written.)
7276 @end deffn
7277
7278 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7279 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7280 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7281
7282 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7283 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7284 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7285 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7286 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7287 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7288 @end deffn
7289
7290 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7291 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7292 @end deffn
7293
7294 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7295 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7296 @end deffn
7297
7298 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7299 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7300
7301 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7302 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7303 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7304 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7305 and ARM9 commands.
7306
7307 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7308 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7309
7310 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7311 Print information about the caches found.
7312 @end deffn
7313
7314 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7315 @cindex ARM966E
7316
7317 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7318 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7319 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7320 and ARM9 commands.
7321
7322 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7323 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7324 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7325 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7326 ARM966E-S TRM.
7327 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7328 as required for BIST support.
7329 @end deffn
7330
7331 @subsection XScale specific commands
7332 @cindex XScale
7333
7334 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7335
7336 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7337 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7338 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7339 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7340 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7341 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7342 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7343
7344 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7345 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7346 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7347 the mini-IC.
7348
7349 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7350 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7351 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7352 code layout in memory:
7353 @example
7354 _vectors:
7355 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7356 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7357 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7358 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7359 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7360 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7361 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7362 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7363 .org 0x100
7364 .long real_reset_vector
7365 .long real_ui_handler
7366 .long real_swi_handler
7367 .long real_pf_abort
7368 .long real_data_abort
7369 .long 0 /* unused */
7370 .long real_irq_handler
7371 .long real_fiq_handler
7372 @end example
7373
7374 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7375 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7376 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7377 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7378 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7379 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7380 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7381 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7382 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7383 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7384 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7385 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7386 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7387 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7388 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7389 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7390 software.
7391
7392 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7393 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7394 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7395 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7396
7397 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7398 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7399 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7400 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7401 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7402 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7403 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7404 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7405 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7406
7407 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7408 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7409
7410 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7411 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7415 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7416 @end deffn
7417
7418 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7419 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7420 @end deffn
7421
7422 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7423 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7424 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7425 @end deffn
7426
7427 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7428 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7429 @end deffn
7430
7431 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7432 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7433 @end deffn
7434
7435 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7436 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7437 @end deffn
7438
7439 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7440 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7441 @end deffn
7442
7443 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7444 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7448 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7449 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7450 and modifying how it is emptied.
7451 @end deffn
7452
7453 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7454 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7455 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7456 The image @var{type} may be one of
7457 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7458 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7459 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7460 @end deffn
7461
7462 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7463 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7464 @cindex vector_catch
7465 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7466 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7467
7468 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7469 @example
7470 0x01 Trap Reset
7471 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7472 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7473 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7474 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7475 0x20 reserved
7476 0x40 Trap IRQ
7477 0x80 Trap FIQ
7478 @end example
7479 @end deffn
7480
7481 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7482 @cindex vector_table
7483
7484 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7485 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7486 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7487 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7488 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7489
7490 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7491
7492 @end deffn
7493
7494 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7495 @cindex ARMv6
7496
7497 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7498 @cindex ARM11
7499
7500 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7501 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7502 which is enabled by default.
7503 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7504 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7505 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7506 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7507 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7508 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7509 @end deffn
7510
7511 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7512 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7513 which is enabled by default.
7514 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7515 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7516 @end deffn
7517
7518 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7519 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7520 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7521 they are disabled by default.
7522 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7523 @end deffn
7524
7525 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7526 @cindex vector_catch
7527 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7528 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7529 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7530
7531 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7532 for certain hardware events.
7533 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7534 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7535 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7536 @end deffn
7537
7538 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7539 @cindex ARMv7
7540
7541 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7542 @cindex Debug Access Port
7543 @cindex DAP
7544 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7545 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7546 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7547
7548 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7549 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7550 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7551 @end deffn
7552
7553 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7554 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7555 @end deffn
7556
7557 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7558 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7559 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7563 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7564 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7565 @end deffn
7566
7567 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7568 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7569 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7570 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7571 @end deffn
7572
7573 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7574 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7575 Defaulting to 0.
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
7579 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
7580 Disabled by default
7581 @end deffn
7582
7583
7584 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
7585 @cindex Cortex-A
7586
7587 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
7588 display information about target caches
7589 @end deffn
7590
7591 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
7592 Initialize core debug
7593 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
7597 Disable SMP mode
7598 @end deffn
7599
7600 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
7601 Enable SMP mode
7602 @end deffn
7603
7604 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
7605 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7609 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7610 @end deffn
7611
7612 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
7613 configure l2x cache
7614 @end deffn
7615
7616
7617 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
7618 @cindex Cortex-R
7619
7620 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
7621 Initialize core debug
7622 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7623 @end deffn
7624
7625 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7626 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7627 @end deffn
7628
7629
7630 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7631 @cindex tracing
7632 @cindex SWO
7633 @cindex SWV
7634 @cindex TPIU
7635 @cindex ITM
7636 @cindex ETM
7637
7638 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7639 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7640 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7641
7642 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7643 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7644 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7645 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7646
7647 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7648 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7649 debugger adapter features.
7650
7651 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7652 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7653
7654 Command options:
7655 @itemize @minus
7656 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7657 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7658 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7659 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7660 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7661 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7662 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7663 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
7664 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7665 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7666 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7667 coding;
7668 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7669 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7670 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7671 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7672 data is to be output via SWO;
7673 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7674 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7675 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7676 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7677 rate automatically.
7678 @end itemize
7679
7680 Example usage:
7681 @enumerate
7682 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7683 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7684 enough to:
7685 @example
7686 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7687 ...
7688 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7689 ...
7690 @end example
7691 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7692 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7693 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7694 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7695 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7696 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7697 @example
7698 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7699 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7700 @end example
7701 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7702 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7703 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7704 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7705 @example
7706 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7707 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7708 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7709 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7710 @end example
7711 @end enumerate
7712 @end deffn
7713
7714 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7715 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7716 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7717 @end deffn
7718
7719 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7720 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7721 @end deffn
7722
7723 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7724 @cindex Cortex-M
7725
7726 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7727 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7728
7729 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7730 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7731 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7732 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7733 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7734 the step command leaves with the core running.
7735
7736 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7737 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7738 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7739
7740 Default is @option{auto}.
7741 @end deffn
7742
7743 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7744 @cindex vector_catch
7745 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7746 for certain hardware events.
7747
7748 Parameters request interception of
7749 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
7750 @option{none} of them,
7751 or one or more of the following:
7752 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
7753 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
7754 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
7755 @option{irq_err},
7756 @option{state_err},
7757 @option{chk_err}, or
7758 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
7759 @option{reset}.
7760 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
7761 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
7762 are mapped to HardFault.
7763 UsageFault checks for
7764 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
7765 must also be explicitly enabled.
7766
7767 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
7768 @end deffn
7769
7770 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
7771 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
7772 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7773 @itemize @minus
7774 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
7775 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
7776 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
7777 @end itemize
7778 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
7779 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
7780 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
7781 the peripherals.
7782 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
7783 @end deffn
7784
7785 @section Intel Architecture
7786
7787 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
7788 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
7789 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
7790 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
7791 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
7792 @itemize
7793 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
7794 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
7795 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
7796 @end itemize
7797
7798 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
7799 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
7800 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
7801
7802 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
7803 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7804 @end deffn
7805
7806 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
7807 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7808 @end deffn
7809
7810 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
7811 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7812 @end deffn
7813
7814 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
7815 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7816 @end deffn
7817
7818 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
7819 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7820 @end deffn
7821
7822 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
7823 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
7824 @end deffn
7825
7826 @section OpenRISC Architecture
7827
7828 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
7829 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
7830
7831 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
7832 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
7833 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
7834 @end deffn
7835 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
7836 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
7837
7838 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
7839
7840 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
7841 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
7842 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
7843 @end deffn
7844
7845 @subsection Registers commands
7846 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
7847 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
7848 included in the generated target descriptor file.
7849
7850 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
7851
7852 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
7853 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
7854 and "timer" groups.
7855
7856 @emph{example:}
7857 @example
7858 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
7859 @end example
7860
7861
7862 @end deffn
7863 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
7864 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
7865
7866 @emph{group} can be "system",
7867 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
7868 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
7872 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
7873 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
7874 @cindex tracing
7875 @cindex libdcc
7876 @cindex DCC
7877 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
7878 the target uses appropriate libraries.
7879 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
7880 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
7881
7882 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
7883 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
7884 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
7885 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
7886 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
7887 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
7888
7889 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
7890 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
7891 arrays of various size integers from the target,
7892 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
7893 The target being debugged may
7894 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
7895 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
7896 each supported by a command:
7897
7898 @itemize
7899 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
7900 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
7901 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
7902 finding out how some fault was triggered.
7903
7904 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
7905 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
7906 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
7907
7908 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
7909 and then displayed at any time.
7910 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
7911
7912 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
7913 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
7914 @end itemize
7915
7916 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
7917 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
7918 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
7919 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
7920 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
7921 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
7922 does the same thing.
7923
7924 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
7925 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
7926 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
7927 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
7928 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
7929
7930 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
7931 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
7932 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
7933 @end deffn
7934
7935 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
7936 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
7937 in the order they triggered.
7938 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
7939 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
7940 history records.
7941 @end deffn
7942
7943 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
7944 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
7945 they have been triggered.
7946 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
7947 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
7948 and associates it with that identifier.
7949
7950 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
7951 are not related except by this command.
7952 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
7953 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
7954 @end deffn
7955
7956
7957 @node JTAG Commands
7958 @chapter JTAG Commands
7959 @cindex JTAG Commands
7960 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
7961 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
7962 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
7963 may be needed to work with targets which require special
7964 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
7965
7966 To use these commands you will need to understand some
7967 of the basics of JTAG, including:
7968
7969 @itemize @bullet
7970 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
7971 devices such as a CPUs.
7972 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
7973 standard state machine (in parallel)
7974 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
7975 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
7976 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
7977 while the reading previous ones.
7978 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
7979 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
7980 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
7981 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
7982 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
7983 registers.
7984 @end itemize
7985
7986 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
7987
7988 These commands are used by developers who need to access
7989 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
7990 the order of TAP state transitions.
7991 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
7992 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
7993 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
7994 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
7995 these commands are not available.
7996
7997 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
7998 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
7999 that specify the entire register.
8000 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8001 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8002 The return value holds the original value of each
8003 of those fields.
8004
8005 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8006 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8007 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8008 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8009 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8010
8011 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8012 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8013
8014 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8015 in that state.
8016 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8017 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8018 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8019
8020 @quotation Warning
8021 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8022 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8023 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8024 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8025 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8026 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8027 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8028 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8029 @end quotation
8030 @end deffn
8031
8032 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8033 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8034 This may be used for performance tuning.
8035
8036 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8037 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8038 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8039 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8040 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8041 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8045 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8046 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8047 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8048 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8049 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8050
8051 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8052 in that state.
8053 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8054 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8055 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8056
8057 @quotation Note
8058 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8059 register values, unlike data register values.
8060 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8061 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8062 @end quotation
8063 @end deffn
8064
8065 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8066 Set values of reset signals.
8067 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8068 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8069 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8070 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8071 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8072 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8073 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8074
8075 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8076 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8077 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8078 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8079 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8080 instead of the TRST signal.
8081 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8082 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8083 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8084 with handlers for that event.
8085 @end deffn
8086
8087 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8088 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8089 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8090 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8091 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8092 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8093 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8094 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8095 The final state must also be stable.
8096 @end deffn
8097
8098 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8099 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8100 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8101 Instructions often need some time
8102 to execute before they take effect.
8103 @end deffn
8104
8105 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8106 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8107
8108 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8109 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8110 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8111 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8112 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8113 @end deffn
8114
8115 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8116 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8117 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8118 must also be enabled.
8119 Default is enabled.
8120 @end deffn
8121
8122 @section TAP state names
8123 @cindex TAP state names
8124
8125 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8126 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8127 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8128 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8129
8130 @itemize @bullet
8131 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8132 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8133 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8134 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8135 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8136 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8137 through the data register
8138 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8139 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8140 for update or more shifting
8141 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8142 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8143 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8144 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8145 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8146 through the instruction register
8147 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8148 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8149 for update or more shifting
8150 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8151 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8152 @end itemize
8153
8154 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8155 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8156 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8157 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8158
8159 @itemize @bullet
8160 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8161 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8162 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8163 may not be as expected.
8164 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8165 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8166 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8167 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8168 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8169 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8170 @end itemize
8171
8172 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8173 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8174
8175 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8176 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8177 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8178 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8179
8180 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8181 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8182 @cindex SVF
8183
8184 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8185 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8186 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8187 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8188
8189 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8190 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8191 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8192 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8193 each command is logged before it is executed.
8194 @end deffn
8195
8196 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8197 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8198 @cindex XSVF
8199
8200 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8201 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8202 Xilinx devices.
8203 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8204 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8205
8206 @quotation Important
8207 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8208 @end quotation
8209
8210 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8211 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8212 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8213 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8214 that TAP.
8215 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8216 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8217 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8218 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8219 @end deffn
8220
8221 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8222 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8223 after building the software.
8224 You may find them useful:
8225
8226 @itemize
8227 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8228 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8229 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8230 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8231 @end itemize
8232
8233 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8234 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8235 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8236 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8237 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8238 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8239 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8240
8241
8242 @node Utility Commands
8243 @chapter Utility Commands
8244 @cindex Utility Commands
8245
8246 @section RAM testing
8247 @cindex RAM testing
8248
8249 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8250 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8251 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8252 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8253 hardware problems.
8254
8255 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8256 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8257 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8258 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8259
8260 Load the memory testing functions with
8261
8262 @example
8263 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8264 @end example
8265
8266 to get access to the following facilities:
8267
8268 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8269 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8270 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8274 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8275 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8276 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8277 @end deffn
8278
8279 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8280 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8281 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8282 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8283 @end deffn
8284
8285 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8286 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8287 @end deffn
8288
8289 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8290 @cindex Firmware recovery
8291
8292 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8293 devices recovery with JTAG.
8294
8295 For quickstart instructions run:
8296 @example
8297 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8298 @end example
8299
8300 @node TFTP
8301 @chapter TFTP
8302 @cindex TFTP
8303 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8304 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8305
8306 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8307 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8308 server (tftpd). For example,
8309
8310 @example
8311 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8312 @end example
8313
8314 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8315 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8316
8317 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8318 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8319 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8320 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8321
8322 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8323 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8324 @cindex GDB
8325 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8326 to debug remote targets.
8327 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8328
8329 @itemize
8330 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8331 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8332 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8333 as shown in this chapter.
8334 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8335 that also will probably need to be configured.
8336 @end itemize
8337
8338 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8339 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8340 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8341 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8342 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8343 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8344
8345 @section Connecting to GDB
8346 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8347 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8348 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8349 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8350 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8351
8352 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8353
8354 @enumerate
8355 @item
8356 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8357 @example
8358 target remote localhost:3333
8359 @end example
8360 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8361
8362 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8363 @example
8364 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8365 @end example
8366 @item
8367 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8368 @example
8369 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8370 @end example
8371 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8372 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8373 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8374 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8375 @end enumerate
8376
8377 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8378 GDB command line.
8379
8380 @section Sample GDB session startup
8381
8382 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8383 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8384 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8385 small ARM program.
8386 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8387 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8388
8389 @example
8390 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8391 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8392 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8393 ...
8394 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8395 ...
8396 (gdb) load
8397 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8398 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8399 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8400 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8401 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8402 (gdb) continue
8403 Continuing.
8404 ...
8405 @end example
8406
8407 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8408 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8409 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8410 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8411
8412 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8413
8414 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8415 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8416 packet size and the device's memory map.
8417 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8418 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8419 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8420
8421 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8422 You may need to set those up by hand.
8423 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8424 something like:
8425
8426 @example
8427 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8428 @end example
8429
8430 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8431
8432 @example
8433 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8434 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8435 @end example
8436
8437 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8438 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8439 do not have such restrictions.
8440
8441 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8442 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8443 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8444
8445 @example
8446 define hook-step
8447 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8448 end
8449 define hookpost-step
8450 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8451 end
8452 @end example
8453
8454 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8455 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8456 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8457 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8458
8459 @section Programming using GDB
8460 @cindex Programming using GDB
8461 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8462
8463 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8464 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8465 @example
8466 gdb_memory_map disable
8467 @end example
8468 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8469 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8470 working area.
8471
8472 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8473 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8474 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8475 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8476
8477 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8478 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8479
8480 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8481 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8482 @example
8483 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8484 @end example
8485
8486 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8487 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8488
8489 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8490 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8491 will be used.
8492
8493 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8494 script can be executed:
8495 @example
8496 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8497 @end example
8498
8499 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8500 can be used.
8501 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8502 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8503 @cindex SMP
8504 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8505 @itemize @bullet
8506 @item j - smp status request
8507 @item J - smp set request
8508 @end itemize
8509
8510 OpenOCD implements :
8511 @itemize @bullet
8512 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8513 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8514 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8515 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8516 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8517 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8518 @end itemize
8519
8520 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8521 @itemize @bullet
8522 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8523 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8524 @example
8525 set $_core 1
8526 #Jc01 packet is sent
8527 print $_core
8528 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8529 @end example
8530
8531 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8532 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8533
8534 @example
8535 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8536 define toggle0
8537 maint packet Jc0
8538 continue
8539 main packet Jc-1
8540 end
8541 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8542 define toggle1
8543 maint packet Jc1
8544 continue
8545 main packet Jc-1
8546 end
8547 @end example
8548 @end itemize
8549
8550 @section RTOS Support
8551 @cindex RTOS Support
8552 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8553
8554 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8555 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8556
8557 @* An example setup is below:
8558
8559 @example
8560 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8561 @end example
8562
8563 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8564
8565 Currently supported rtos's include:
8566 @itemize @bullet
8567 @item @option{eCos}
8568 @item @option{ThreadX}
8569 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8570 @item @option{linux}
8571 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8572 @item @option{embKernel}
8573 @item @option{mqx}
8574 @end itemize
8575
8576 @quotation Note
8577 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8578 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8579 @end quotation
8580
8581 @table @code
8582 @item eCos symbols
8583 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8584 @item ThreadX symbols
8585 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8586 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8587 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8588 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8589 @tex
8590 \begingroup
8591 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8592 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8593 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8594 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8595 \par
8596 \endgroup
8597 @end tex
8598 @item linux symbols
8599 init_task.
8600 @item ChibiOS symbols
8601 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8602 @item embKernel symbols
8603 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8604 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8605 @item mqx symbols
8606 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8607 @end table
8608
8609 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8610 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8611
8612 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8613 along with the project:
8614
8615 @table @code
8616 @item FreeRTOS
8617 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8618 @end table
8619
8620 @node Tcl Scripting API
8621 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8622 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8623 @cindex Tcl scripts
8624 @section API rules
8625
8626 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8627 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8628 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8629
8630 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8631 pair list and lists.
8632
8633 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8634 list.
8635
8636 @example
8637 > set foo(me) Duane
8638 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8639 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8640 > set foo(duck) Donald
8641 @end example
8642
8643 If one does this:
8644
8645 @example
8646 > set foo
8647 @end example
8648
8649 The result is:
8650
8651 @example
8652 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8653 @end example
8654
8655 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8656
8657 @verbatim
8658 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8659 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8660 }
8661 @end verbatim
8662
8663 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8664 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8665
8666 @section Internal low-level Commands
8667
8668 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8669 invoke directly.
8670
8671 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8672 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8673 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8674
8675 @itemize @bullet
8676 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8677
8678 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8679 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8680
8681 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8682 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8683
8684 Return information about the flash banks
8685
8686 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8687
8688 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8689 its execution. Example:
8690
8691 @example
8692 > capture "reset init"
8693 @end example
8694
8695 @end itemize
8696
8697 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8698 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8699 called "flash_banks".
8700
8701 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8702
8703 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8704 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8705 holds one of the following values:
8706
8707 @itemize @bullet
8708 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8709 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8710 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8711 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8712 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8713 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8714 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8715 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8716 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8717 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8718 @end itemize
8719
8720 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8721
8722 @quotation Note
8723 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8724 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8725 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8726 is jim, not real tcl).
8727 @end quotation
8728
8729 @section Tcl RPC server
8730 @cindex RPC
8731
8732 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8733 commands and receive the results.
8734
8735 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8736 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8737 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8738 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8739 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8740
8741 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8742 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8743 @command{capture} command.
8744
8745 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
8746
8747 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
8748 @cindex RPC Notifications
8749
8750 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8751 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8752
8753 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
8754 in the following format.
8755
8756 @verbatim
8757 type target_event event [event-name]
8758 type target_state state [state-name]
8759 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
8760 @end verbatim
8761
8762 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
8763 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
8764 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8765 Defaults to off.
8766
8767 @end deffn
8768
8769 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
8770 @cindex RPC trace output
8771
8772 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
8773 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
8774
8775 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
8776
8777 @verbatim
8778 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
8779 @end verbatim
8780
8781 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
8782 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
8783 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
8784 Defaults to off.
8785
8786 See an example application here:
8787 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
8788
8789 @end deffn
8790
8791 @node FAQ
8792 @chapter FAQ
8793 @cindex faq
8794 @enumerate
8795 @anchor{faqrtck}
8796 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
8797 @cindex RTCK
8798 @cindex adaptive clocking
8799 @*
8800
8801 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
8802 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
8803 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
8804 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
8805
8806 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
8807 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
8808 for example. There are 2 basic options:
8809 @enumerate
8810 @item
8811 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
8812 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
8813 @item
8814 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
8815 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
8816 @end enumerate
8817
8818 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
8819 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
8820 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
8821 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
8822 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
8823 power).
8824
8825 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
8826 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
8827 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
8828 ARM926 scenario).
8829 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
8830 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
8831 JTAG can use a faster clock.
8832
8833 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
8834 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
8835 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
8836 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
8837
8838 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
8839
8840 In order to make use of this,
8841 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
8842 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
8843
8844 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
8845 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
8846 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
8847 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
8848 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
8849
8850 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
8851 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
8852 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
8853 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
8854
8855 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
8856 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
8857 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
8858 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
8859 with a CPLD.
8860 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
8861 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
8862 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
8863 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
8864 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
8865 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
8866
8867 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
8868
8869 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
8870
8871 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
8872 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
8873 depending on the chips on your board.
8874 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
8875 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
8876 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
8877
8878 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
8879 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
8880 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
8881
8882 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
8883 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
8884 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
8885 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
8886
8887 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
8888 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
8889 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
8890 this way.
8891
8892 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
8893 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
8894 clock rate.
8895 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
8896 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
8897 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8898
8899 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
8900
8901 @example
8902 # Example: 1.234MHz
8903 adapter_khz 1234
8904 @end example
8905
8906
8907 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
8908
8909 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
8910 around Windows filenames.
8911
8912 @example
8913 > echo \a
8914
8915 > echo @{\a@}
8916 \a
8917 > echo "\a"
8918
8919 >
8920 @end example
8921
8922
8923 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
8924
8925 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
8926 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
8927 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
8928
8929 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
8930 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
8931 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
8932
8933 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
8934 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
8935 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
8936
8937 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
8938
8939 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
8940 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
8941 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
8942 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
8943
8944 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
8945 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
8946 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
8947
8948 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
8949 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
8950
8951 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
8952 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
8953 memory read caused data abort".
8954
8955 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
8956 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
8957 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
8958 be done, feel free to add this here.
8959
8960 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
8961 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
8962 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
8963 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
8964 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
8965 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
8966 gracefully stops.
8967
8968 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
8969 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
8970 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
8971
8972 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
8973 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
8974 bytes. Painful...
8975
8976
8977 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
8978 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
8979
8980 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
8981 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
8982 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
8983 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
8984 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
8985 reset, everything else should work fine.
8986
8987 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
8988 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
8989 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
8990 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
8991
8992 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
8993 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
8994 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
8995 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
8996
8997 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
8998
8999 @item @b{USB Power} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the
9000 following error messages: "Error: ft2232.c:201 ft2232_read(): FT_Read returned:
9001 4" and "Error: ft2232.c:365 ft2232_send_and_recv(): couldn't read from FT2232".
9002 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9003
9004 First of all, the reason might be the USB power supply. Try using a self-powered
9005 hub instead of a direct connection to your computer. Secondly, the error code 4
9006 corresponds to an FT_IO_ERROR, which means that the driver for the FTDI USB
9007 chip ran into some sort of error - this points us to a USB problem.
9008
9009 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9010 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9011 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9012
9013 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9014 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9015
9016 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9017 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9018 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9019 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9020 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9021 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9022 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9023 clock frequency?
9024
9025 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9026 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9027 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9028 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9029 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9030
9031 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9032
9033 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9034 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9035 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9036 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9037 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9038 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9039 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9040
9041 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9042
9043 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9044 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9045 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9046 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9047
9048 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9049 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9050 particular order?
9051
9052 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9053 the same order used by the hardware.
9054
9055 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9056 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9057 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9058 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9059 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9060 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9061
9062 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9063 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9064 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9065 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9066
9067 @itemize @bullet
9068 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9069 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9070 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9071 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9072 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9073 @end itemize
9074
9075 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9076
9077 @itemize @bullet
9078 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9079 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9080 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9081 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9082 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9083 @end itemize
9084
9085
9086 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9087 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9088 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9089
9090 TODO.
9091
9092 @end enumerate
9093
9094 @node Tcl Crash Course
9095 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9096 @cindex Tcl
9097
9098 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9099 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9100 how the Tcl scripts work.
9101
9102 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9103 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9104 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9105 OpenOCD.
9106
9107 @section Tcl Rule #1
9108 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9109 @enumerate
9110 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9111 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9112 @end enumerate
9113
9114 The Tcl equal is this:
9115
9116 @enumerate
9117 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9118 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9119 @end enumerate
9120
9121 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9122 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9123
9124 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9125 There is a second pair of rules.
9126 @enumerate
9127 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9128 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9129 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9130 in Tcl.
9131 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9132 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9133 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9134 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9135 @end enumerate
9136
9137 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9138 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9139 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9140 Everything is a string}
9141
9142 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9143 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9144 difference is subtle.
9145 @enumerate
9146 @item Parse Time
9147 @item Evaluation Time
9148 @end enumerate
9149
9150 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9151 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9152 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9153
9154 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9155 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9156 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9157 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9158
9159 @itemize @bullet
9160 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9161 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9162 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9163 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9164 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9165 @example
9166 # bash example
9167 X=`date`
9168 echo "The Date is: $X"
9169 # Tcl example
9170 set X [date]
9171 puts "The Date is: $X"
9172 @end example
9173 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9174 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9175 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9176 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9177 is a string}
9178 @example
9179 set x "Dinner"
9180 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9181 @end example
9182 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9183 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9184 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9185 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9186 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9187 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9188 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9189 @end itemize
9190
9191 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9192
9193 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9194
9195 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9196
9197 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9198 the normal way.
9199
9200 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9201 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9202 line is immedatly executed.
9203
9204 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9205 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9206
9207 @subsection Command Execution
9208
9209 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9210 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9211 control flow operators.
9212
9213 Commands are executed like this:
9214
9215 @enumerate
9216 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9217 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9218 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9219 @end enumerate
9220
9221 It sort of works like this:
9222 @example
9223 for(;;)@{
9224 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9225
9226 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9227
9228 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9229 @}
9230 @end example
9231
9232 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9233 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9234 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9235 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9236 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9237 ``LookupCommand()''
9238
9239 @subsection The FOR command
9240
9241 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9242 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9243 command just like any other command.
9244
9245 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9246 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9247 are:
9248
9249 @enumerate 0
9250 @item The ascii text 'for'
9251 @item The start text
9252 @item The test expression
9253 @item The next text
9254 @item The body text
9255 @end enumerate
9256
9257 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9258 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9259 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9260 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9261
9262 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9263 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9264
9265 @example
9266 int
9267 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9268 int *argc,
9269 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9270 @end example
9271
9272 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9273 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9274 still operates in the same basic way.
9275
9276 @subsection FOR command implementation
9277
9278 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9279 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9280
9281 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9282
9283 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9284
9285 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9286 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9287 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9288
9289 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9290 expression and returns a value.
9291
9292 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9293 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9294 @example
9295 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9296
9297 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9298
9299 int
9300 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9301 int argc,
9302 char **argv )
9303 @{
9304 if( argc != 5 )@{
9305 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9306 return ERROR;
9307 @}
9308
9309 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9310
9311 // Execute the start statement.
9312 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9313
9314 // Top of loop test
9315 for(;;)@{
9316 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9317 if( i == 0 )
9318 break;
9319
9320 // Execute the body
9321 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9322
9323 // Execute the LOOP part
9324 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9325 @}
9326
9327 // Return no error
9328 SetResult( interp, "" );
9329 return SUCCESS;
9330 @}
9331 @end example
9332
9333 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9334 in the same basic way.
9335
9336 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9337
9338 @subsection source and find commands
9339 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9340 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9341 @*Remember the parsing rules
9342 @enumerate
9343 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9344 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9345 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9346 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9347 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9348 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9349 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9350 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9351 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9352 @end enumerate
9353 @subsection format command
9354 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9355 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9356 @b{sprintf()}.
9357 @b{Example}
9358 @example
9359 set x 6
9360 set y 7
9361 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9362 @end example
9363 @enumerate
9364 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9365 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9366 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9367 @* Refer to Rule #1
9368 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9369 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9370 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9371 @end enumerate
9372 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9373 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9374 @example
9375 #1 Good
9376 proc someproc @{@} @{
9377 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9378 @}
9379 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9380 #2 Good - no variables
9381 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9382 #3 Good Curly Braces
9383 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9384 puts "Time: [date]"
9385 @}
9386 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9387 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9388 @end example
9389 @enumerate
9390 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9391 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9392 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9393 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9394 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9395 command.
9396 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9397 @*There are 4 examples:
9398 @enumerate
9399 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9400 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9401 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9402 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9403 @end enumerate
9404
9405 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9406 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9407 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9408
9409 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9410 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9411 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9412 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9413 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9414 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9415 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9416 @end enumerate
9417 @subsection Global Variables
9418 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9419 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9420 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9421 @example
9422 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9423 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9424 global x #Global variable X
9425 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9426 @}
9427 @end example
9428 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9429 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9430 @example
9431 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9432 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9433 # Create var name
9434 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9435 # Make it a global
9436 global $vn
9437 # Set it.
9438 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9439 @}
9440 @end example
9441 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9442 @example
9443 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9444 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9445 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9446 @}
9447 @end example
9448
9449 @include fdl.texi
9450
9451 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9452 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9453 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9454 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9455 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9456 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9457
9458 @printindex cp
9459
9460 @node Command and Driver Index
9461 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9462 @printindex fn
9463
9464 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)